blob: eb249889b9d9c7e65e3a0bd0d72a80a165d04005 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200459 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200460 - noepoll
461 - nokqueue
462 - nopoll
463 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200468 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100469 - tune.maxaccept
470 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200471 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200472 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100473 - tune.rcvbuf.client
474 - tune.rcvbuf.server
475 - tune.sndbuf.client
476 - tune.sndbuf.server
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100477 - tune.zlib.memlevel
478 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100479
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200480 * Debugging
481 - debug
482 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200483
484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004853.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200486------------------------------------
487
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200488ca-base <dir>
489 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200490 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
491 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493chroot <jail dir>
494 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
495 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
496 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
497 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
498 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
499 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501crt-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
503 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
504 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506daemon
507 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
508 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
509 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
510
511gid <number>
512 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
513 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
514 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
515 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517group <group name>
518 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
519 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100520
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200521log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
523 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100524 configured with "log global".
525
526 <address> can be one of:
527
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100528 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100529 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
530 port).
531
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100532 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
533 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
534 port).
535
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100536 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
537 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
538 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
539 writeable).
540
541 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542
543 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
544 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
545 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
546
547 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200548 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
549 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
550 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
551 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
552 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
553 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200555 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100557log-send-hostname [<string>]
558 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
559 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
560 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
561 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
562 the logs.
563
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000564log-tag <string>
565 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
566 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
567 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
568 running on the same host.
569
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570nbproc <number>
571 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
572 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
573 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
574 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
575 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
576
577pidfile <pidfile>
578 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
579 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
580 starting the process. See also "daemon".
581
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200582stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
583 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
584 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
585 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
586 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
587 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
588 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
589 the number of processes used.
590
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200591stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
592 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
593 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
594 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
595 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200596
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200597 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
598 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
599 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200600
601stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
602 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
603 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100604 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605
606stats maxconn <connections>
607 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
608 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
609
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610uid <number>
611 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
612 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
613 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
614 one. See also "gid" and "user".
615
616ulimit-n <number>
617 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
618 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
619 option.
620
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100621unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
622 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
623
624 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
625 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
626 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
627 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
628 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
629 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
630 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
631 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
632 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
633 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
634
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635user <user name>
636 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
637 See also "uid" and "group".
638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200639node <name>
640 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
641
642 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
643 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
644 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
645 traffic.
646
647description <text>
648 Add a text that describes the instance.
649
650 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
651 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
652 "<" and ">" characters.
653
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006553.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656-----------------------
657
658maxconn <number>
659 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
660 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
661 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
662 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
663
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200664maxconnrate <number>
665 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
666 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
667 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
668 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
669 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
670 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
671 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
672 fairness.
673
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100674maxpipes <number>
675 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
676 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
677 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
678 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
679 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
680 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
681
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200682maxsslconn <number>
683 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
684 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
685 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
686 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
687 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
688 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
689 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691noepoll
692 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
693 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
694 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
695
696nokqueue
697 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
698 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
699 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
700
701nopoll
702 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
703 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100704 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
706 "nokqueue".
707
708nosepoll
709 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
710 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
711 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
712
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100713nosplice
714 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
715 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
716 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100717 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100718 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
719 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
720 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
721 "option splice-response".
722
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200723spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
724 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
725 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
726 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
727 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
728 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
729
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200730tune.bufsize <number>
731 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
732 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
733 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
734 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
735 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
736 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
737 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
738 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400739 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
740 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
741 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200742
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200743tune.chksize <number>
744 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
745 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
746 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
747 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
748 checks whenever possible.
749
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200750tune.http.maxhdr <number>
751 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
752 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
753 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
754 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
755 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
756 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
757 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
758 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
759 limit too high.
760
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100761tune.maxaccept <number>
762 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
763 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
764 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100765 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100766 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
767 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100768 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100769 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
770
771tune.maxpollevents <number>
772 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
773 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
774 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
775 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
776 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
777
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200778tune.maxrewrite <number>
779 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
780 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
781 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
782 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
783 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
784 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
785 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
786 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
787 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
788 bufsize.
789
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200790tune.pipesize <number>
791 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
792 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
793 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
794 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
795 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
796 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
797
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100798tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
799tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
800 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
801 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
802 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
803 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
804 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
805 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
806 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
807
808tune.sndbuf.client <number>
809tune.sndbuf.server <number>
810 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
811 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
812 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
813 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
814 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
815 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
816 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
817 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
818 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
819 notifying haproxy again.
820
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100821tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
822 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
823 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
824 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
825 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
826 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
827
828tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
829 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
830 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
831 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
832 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008343.3. Debugging
835--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836
837debug
838 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
839 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
840 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
841 system startup.
842
843quiet
844 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
845 line argument "-q".
846
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008483.4. Userlists
849--------------
850It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
851http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
852it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
853
854userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100855 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100856 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
857
858group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100859 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100860 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
861 proceeded by "users" keyword.
862
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100863user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
864 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100865 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
866 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100867 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
868 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100869 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
870 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
871
872
873 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100874 userlist L1
875 group G1 users tiger,scott
876 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100877
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100878 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
879 user scott insecure-password elgato
880 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100881
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100882 userlist L2
883 group G1
884 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100885
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100886 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
887 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
888 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100889
890 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200892
8933.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200894----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200895It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
896haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
897pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
898identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
899or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
900Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
901known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
902the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
903process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
904during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
905tables.
906
907peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400908 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200909 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
910
911peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
912 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
913 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
914 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
915 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
916 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
917 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
918
919 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
920 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
921
922 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
923 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
924 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
925 across all peers.
926
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200927 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200928 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100929 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
930 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
931 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200932
933 backend mybackend
934 mode tcp
935 balance roundrobin
936 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
937 stick on src
938
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100939 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
940 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200941
942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009434. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200946Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
947 - defaults <name>
948 - frontend <name>
949 - backend <name>
950 - listen <name>
951
952A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
953its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
954section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100955section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956
957A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
958connections.
959
960A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
961to forward incoming connections.
962
963A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
964parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100966All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
967'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
968case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
969
970Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
971logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
972proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
973However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
974name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
975
976Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
977and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100978bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100979protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
980modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
981arbitrary criteria.
982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009844.1. Proxy keywords matrix
985--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200987The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
988limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
989they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
990limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100991marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200992option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200993and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
994with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
995specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100996
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100998 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
999------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1000acl - X X X
1001appsession - - X X
1002backlog X X X -
1003balance X - X X
1004bind - X X -
1005bind-process X X X X
1006block - X X X
1007capture cookie - X X -
1008capture request header - X X -
1009capture response header - X X -
1010clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001011compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001012contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1013cookie X - X X
1014default-server X - X X
1015default_backend X X X -
1016description - X X X
1017disabled X X X X
1018dispatch - - X X
1019enabled X X X X
1020errorfile X X X X
1021errorloc X X X X
1022errorloc302 X X X X
1023-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1024errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001025force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001026fullconn X - X X
1027grace X X X X
1028hash-type X - X X
1029http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001030http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001031http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001032http-request - X X X
1033id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001034ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001035log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036maxconn X X X -
1037mode X X X X
1038monitor fail - X X -
1039monitor-net X X X -
1040monitor-uri X X X -
1041option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1042option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1043option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1044option allbackups (*) X - X X
1045option checkcache (*) X - X X
1046option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1047option contstats (*) X X X -
1048option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1049option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1050option forceclose (*) X X X X
1051-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1052option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001053option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001054option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001055option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1056option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1057option httpchk X - X X
1058option httpclose (*) X X X X
1059option httplog X X X X
1060option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001061option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001062option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001063option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1064option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1065option logasap (*) X X X -
1066option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001067option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001068option nolinger (*) X X X X
1069option originalto X X X X
1070option persist (*) X - X X
1071option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001072option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001073option smtpchk X - X X
1074option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1075option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1076option splice-request (*) X X X X
1077option splice-response (*) X X X X
1078option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1079option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1080-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1081option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1082option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1083option tcpka X X X X
1084option tcplog X X X X
1085option transparent (*) X - X X
1086persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1087rate-limit sessions X X X -
1088redirect - X X X
1089redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1090redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1091reqadd - X X X
1092reqallow - X X X
1093reqdel - X X X
1094reqdeny - X X X
1095reqiallow - X X X
1096reqidel - X X X
1097reqideny - X X X
1098reqipass - X X X
1099reqirep - X X X
1100reqisetbe - X X X
1101reqitarpit - X X X
1102reqpass - X X X
1103reqrep - X X X
1104-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1105reqsetbe - X X X
1106reqtarpit - X X X
1107retries X - X X
1108rspadd - X X X
1109rspdel - X X X
1110rspdeny - X X X
1111rspidel - X X X
1112rspideny - X X X
1113rspirep - X X X
1114rsprep - X X X
1115server - - X X
1116source X - X X
1117srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001118stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001119stats auth X - X X
1120stats enable X - X X
1121stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001122stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001123stats realm X - X X
1124stats refresh X - X X
1125stats scope X - X X
1126stats show-desc X - X X
1127stats show-legends X - X X
1128stats show-node X - X X
1129stats uri X - X X
1130-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1131stick match - - X X
1132stick on - - X X
1133stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001134stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001135stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001136tcp-request connection - X X -
1137tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001138tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001139tcp-response content - - X X
1140tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001141timeout check X - X X
1142timeout client X X X -
1143timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1144timeout connect X - X X
1145timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1146timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1147timeout http-request X X X X
1148timeout queue X - X X
1149timeout server X - X X
1150timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1151timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001152timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001153transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001154unique-id-format X X X -
1155unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001156use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001157use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001158------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1159 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1163---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001164
1165This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1166
1167
1168acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1169 Declare or complete an access list.
1170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1171 no | yes | yes | yes
1172 Example:
1173 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1174 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1175 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001177 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001178
1179
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001180appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1181 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001182 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1184 no | no | yes | yes
1185 Arguments :
1186 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1187 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1188
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001189 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001190 checked in each cookie value.
1191
1192 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1193 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1194 milliseconds.
1195
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001196 request-learn
1197 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1198 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1199 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1200 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1201 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1202 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1203
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001204 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1205 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1206 data following this prefix.
1207
1208 Example :
1209 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1210
1211 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1212 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1213
1214 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1215 2 modes are currently supported :
1216 - path-parameters :
1217 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1218 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1219 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1220 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1221 - query-string :
1222 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1223 query string.
1224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001225 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1226 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1227 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1228 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001229 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1230 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1231 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1233 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1234
1235 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1236
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001237 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1238 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1239 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241 Example :
1242 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1243
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001244 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1245 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001246
1247
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001248backlog <conns>
1249 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1251 yes | yes | yes | no
1252 Arguments :
1253 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1254 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001255 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001256
1257 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1258 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1259 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1260 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1261 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1262 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1263 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1264 backlog parameter.
1265
1266 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1267 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1268 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1269
1270 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1271
1272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001273balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001274balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001275 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1277 yes | no | yes | yes
1278 Arguments :
1279 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1280 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1281 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1282 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1283
1284 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1285 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1286 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1287 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001288 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1289 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1290 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1291 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1292 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1293 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1294 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1295 it, so that you don't worry.
1296
1297 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1298 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1299 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1300 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1301 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1302 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1303 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1304 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001306 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1307 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1308 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1309 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1310 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1311 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1312 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1313 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1314
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001315 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1316 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1317 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1318 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001319 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001320 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1321 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1322 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1323 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1324 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001325 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1326 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1327 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1328 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1329 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1330 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001332 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1333 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1334 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1335 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1336 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1337 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1338 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1339 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001340 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001342 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1343 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1344 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001345
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001346 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1347 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1348 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1349 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1350 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1351 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1352 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1353 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1354 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1355 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1356 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1357 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001358
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001359 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001360 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1361 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1362 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1363 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1364 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1365 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1366 URIs start with a leading "/".
1367
1368 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1369 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1370 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1371 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001373 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001374 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1375
1376 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001377 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1378 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1379 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1380 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1381 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1382 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1383 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1384 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1385 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1386 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1387 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1388 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1389 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1390 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1391 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1392 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1393 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1394 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1395 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001396
1397 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1398 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1399 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1400 server will receive the request.
1401
1402 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1403 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1404 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1405 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1406 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001407 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1408 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1409 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001410
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001411 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1412 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1413 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1414 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1415 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001417 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001418 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1419 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1420 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1421
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001422 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1423 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1424 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1425
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001426 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001427 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001428 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1429 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1430 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1431 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1432 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1433 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001434 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001435 used instead.
1436
1437 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1438 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1439 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1440 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1441
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001442 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1443 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1444 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1445
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001446 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001447
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001448 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001449 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1450 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001451
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001452 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001453 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001454
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001455 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1456 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1457 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001458
1459 Examples :
1460 balance roundrobin
1461 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001462 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001463 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1464 balance hdr(host)
1465 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001466
1467 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1468 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1469
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001470 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001471 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1472 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1473 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1474 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1475
1476 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1477 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1478 defaults to 16 kB.
1479
1480 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1481 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1482
1483 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1484 Round Robin.
1485
1486 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1487 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1488 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1489 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1490
1491 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1492
1493 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001494 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001495 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1496 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1497 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001498
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001499 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1500 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001501
1502
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001503bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1504bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001505 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1507 no | yes | yes | no
1508 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001509 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1510 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1511 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1512 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001513 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001514
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001515 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1516 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001517 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1518 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1519 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001520 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1521 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1522 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1523 the range.
1524
1525 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1526 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1527 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1528 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1529 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1530 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1531 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001532 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001533 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001535 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1536 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1537 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1538 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1539 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1540 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1541 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1542 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1543
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001544 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1545 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1546 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1547 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001548
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001549 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1550 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1551 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1552 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1553 in a frontend.
1554
1555 Example :
1556 listen http_proxy
1557 bind :80,:443
1558 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001559 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001560
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001561 listen http_https_proxy
1562 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001563 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001564
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001565 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001566 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001567
1568
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001569bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1570 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1572 yes | yes | yes | yes
1573 Arguments :
1574 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1575 may be used to override a default value.
1576
1577 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1578 option may be combined with other numbers.
1579
1580 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1581 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1582 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1583 missing from all processes.
1584
1585 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1586 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1587 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1588 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1589
1590 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1591 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1592 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1593 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1594 and 'even' instances.
1595
1596 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1597 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1598 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1599 32.
1600
1601 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1602 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1603
1604 Example :
1605 listen app_ip1
1606 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001607 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001608
1609 listen app_ip2
1610 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001611 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001612
1613 listen management
1614 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001615 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001616
1617 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1618
1619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620block { if | unless } <condition>
1621 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1623 no | yes | yes | yes
1624
1625 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1626 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001627 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001628 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001629 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1630 "block" statements per instance.
1631
1632 Example:
1633 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1634 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1635 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1636 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001638 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639
1640
1641capture cookie <name> len <length>
1642 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1644 no | yes | yes | no
1645 Arguments :
1646 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1647 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1648 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1649 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1650 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1651
1652 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1653 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1654 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1655 right if it exceeds <length>.
1656
1657 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1658 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1659 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1660 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1661
1662 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1663 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1664 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1665
1666 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1667 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1668 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1669 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001670 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001671 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1672
1673 Example:
1674 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1675
1676 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001677 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678
1679
1680capture request header <name> len <length>
1681 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1683 no | yes | yes | no
1684 Arguments :
1685 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001686 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001687 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1688 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1689 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1690
1691 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1692 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1693 it exceeds <length>.
1694
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001695 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001696 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1697 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001698 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1699 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1700 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1701 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001702 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001703 environments to find where the request came from.
1704
1705 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1706 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1707 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1708 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
1710 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1711 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1712 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1713 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1714
1715 Example:
1716 capture request header Host len 15
1717 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1718 capture request header Referrer len 15
1719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001720 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721 about logging.
1722
1723
1724capture response header <name> len <length>
1725 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1727 no | yes | yes | no
1728 Arguments :
1729 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001730 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001731 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1732 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1733 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1734
1735 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1736 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1737 it exceeds <length>.
1738
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001739 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1741 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1742 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001743 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1744 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1745 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1746 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747
1748 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1749 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1750 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1751 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1752
1753 Example:
1754 capture response header Content-length len 9
1755 capture response header Location len 15
1756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001757 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758 about logging.
1759
1760
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001761clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1764 yes | yes | yes | no
1765 Arguments :
1766 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1767 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1768 as explained at the top of this document.
1769
1770 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1771 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1772 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1773 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1774 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1775 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1776 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1777 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001778 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001779 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1780 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1781
1782 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1783 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1784 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1785 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1786 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1787 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1788
1789 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1790 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1791
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001792 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1793 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001795compression algo [ gzip ] ...
1796compression type ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001797compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001798 Enable HTTP compression.
1799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1800 yes | yes | yes | yes
1801 Arguments :
1802 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1803 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001804 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1805
1806 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1807 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1808 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1809 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1810 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
1811 and need to prevent it from emitting invalid payloads. In this case, simply
1812 removing the header in the configuration does not work because it applies
1813 before the header is parsed, so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The
1814 "offload" setting should then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001815
1816 Examples :
1817 compression algo gzip
1818 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001820contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1823 yes | no | yes | yes
1824 Arguments :
1825 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1827 as explained at the top of this document.
1828
1829 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001830 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001831 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1833 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1834 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1835 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1836
1837 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1838 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1839 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1840 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1841 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1842 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1843
1844 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1845 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1846 instead.
1847
1848 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1849 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1850
1851
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001852cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001853 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1854 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001855 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1857 yes | no | yes | yes
1858 Arguments :
1859 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1860 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1861 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1862 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1863 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1864 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1865 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1866 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1867 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1868
1869 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1870 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1871 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1872 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1873 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1874 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1875 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1876 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1877 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1878 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1879 "insert" and "prefix".
1880
1881 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001882 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001883
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001884 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001885 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1886 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1887 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1888 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1889 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1890 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1891 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1892 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1893 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1894 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
1896 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1897 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1898 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1899 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1900 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1901 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1902 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1903 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1904 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1905 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001906 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1907 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1908 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001909
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001910 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1911 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1912 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001913 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1914 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1915 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1916 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001917 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1918 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1919 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001920
1921 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1922 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1923 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1924 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1925 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1926 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1927 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1928 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1929 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1930
1931 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1932 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1933 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1934 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1935 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1936 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1937 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1938 persistence cookie in the cache.
1939 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1940
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001941 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1942 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1943 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1944 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1945 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1946 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1947 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1948 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1949 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1950 they logout.
1951
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001952 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1953 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1954 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1955 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1956
1957 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1958 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1959 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1960 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1961 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1962 this attribute.
1963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001964 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001965 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001966 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1967 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1968 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1969 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1970 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1971 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001972
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001973 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1974 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1975 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1976 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1977 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1978 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1979 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1980 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1981 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1982 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1983 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1984 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1985 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1986 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1987 the site.
1988
1989 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1990 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1991 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1992 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1993 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1994 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1995 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1996 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1997 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1998 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1999 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2000 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2001 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2002 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2003 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2004 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002006 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2007 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2008 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2009 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 Examples :
2012 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2013 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2014 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002015 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002017 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002018 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002021default-server [param*]
2022 Change default options for a server in a backend
2023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2024 yes | no | yes | yes
2025 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002026 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2027 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2028 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2029 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002030
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002031 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002032 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2033
2034 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037default_backend <backend>
2038 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2040 yes | yes | yes | no
2041 Arguments :
2042 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2043
2044 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2045 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2046 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2047 will catch all undetermined requests.
2048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002049 Example :
2050
2051 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2052 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2053 default_backend dynamic
2054
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002055 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2056
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
2058disabled
2059 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2061 yes | yes | yes | yes
2062 Arguments : none
2063
2064 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2065 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2066 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2067 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2068 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2069 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2070 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2071
2072 See also : "enabled"
2073
2074
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002075dispatch <address>:<port>
2076 Set a default server address
2077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2078 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002079 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002080
2081 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2082 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2083 during start-up.
2084
2085 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2086 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2087 possible with normal servers.
2088
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002089 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002090 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2091 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2092 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2093 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2094
2095 See also : "server"
2096
2097
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098enabled
2099 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2101 yes | yes | yes | yes
2102 Arguments : none
2103
2104 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2105 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2106
2107 See also : "disabled"
2108
2109
2110errorfile <code> <file>
2111 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2113 yes | yes | yes | yes
2114 Arguments :
2115 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002116 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002117
2118 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002119 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002120 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002121 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2122 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123
2124 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2125 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2126 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2127
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002128 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002130 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2131 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2132 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2133 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2134
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002135 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2136 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2137 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2138 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2139 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2140 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2141
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002142 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2143 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2144 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002145 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2147
2148 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2149
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002150 Example :
2151 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2152 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2153 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2154
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002155
2156errorloc <code> <url>
2157errorloc302 <code> <url>
2158 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2160 yes | yes | yes | yes
2161 Arguments :
2162 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002163 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002164
2165 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2166 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2167 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2168 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2169 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2170
2171 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2172 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2173 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2174
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002175 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2176
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002177 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2178 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2179 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2180 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2181 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2182 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2183 request.
2184
2185 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2186
2187
2188errorloc303 <code> <url>
2189 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2191 yes | yes | yes | yes
2192 Arguments :
2193 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2194 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2195
2196 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2197 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2198 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2199 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2200 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2201
2202 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2203 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2204 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2205
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002206 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2207
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002208 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2209 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2210 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2211 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002212 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002213
2214 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2215
2216
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002217force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2218 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2220 no | yes | yes | yes
2221
2222 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2223 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2224 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2225 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2226 marked down for maintenance operations.
2227
2228 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2229 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2230 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2231 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2232 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2233 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2234 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2235 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2236 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2237
2238 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2239 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2240 is used.
2241
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002242 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002243 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002244
2245
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002246fullconn <conns>
2247 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 yes | no | yes | yes
2250 Arguments :
2251 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2252 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2253
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002254 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002255 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002256 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002257 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2258 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2259 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2260 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2261 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002262 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002263
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002264 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2265 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2266 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2267
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002268 Example :
2269 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2270 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2271 # connections.
2272 backend dynamic
2273 fullconn 10000
2274 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2275 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2276
2277 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2278
2279
2280grace <time>
2281 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002283 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002284 Arguments :
2285 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2286 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2287 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2288
2289 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2290 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002291 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002292 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2293
2294 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2295 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2296 simplify it.
2297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002299hash-type <method>
2300 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2302 yes | no | yes | yes
2303 Arguments :
2304 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2305 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2306 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2307 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2308 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2309 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2310 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2311 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2312 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2313
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002314 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2315 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2316 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2317 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2318 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2319 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2320 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2321 this value.
2322
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002323 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2324 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2325 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2326 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2327 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2328 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2329 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2330 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2331 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2332 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2333 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2334 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2335 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2336
2337 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2338
2339 See also : "balance", "server"
2340
2341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342http-check disable-on-404
2343 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002345 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002346 Arguments : none
2347
2348 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2349 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2350 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2351 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2352 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2353 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2354 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2355 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002356 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2357 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2358 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2359
2360 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2361
2362
2363http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002364 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002366 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002367 Arguments :
2368 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2369 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002370 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002371 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2372 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2373 details on the supported keywords.
2374
2375 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2376 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2377 with the usual backslash ('\').
2378
2379 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2380 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2381 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2382 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2383 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2384
2385 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002386 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002387 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2388 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2389 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2390
2391 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002392 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002393 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2394 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2395 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2396 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2397
2398 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002399 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002400 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2401 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2402 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2403 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2404 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2405 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2406 trace).
2407
2408 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002409 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002410 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2411 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2412 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2413 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2414 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2415 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2416
2417 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2418 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2419 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2420 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2421 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2422 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2423 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2424 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2425
2426 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2427 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2428
2429 Examples :
2430 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002431 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002432
2433 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002434 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002435
2436 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002437 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002438
2439 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002440 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002441
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002442 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002443
2444
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002445http-check send-state
2446 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2448 yes | no | yes | yes
2449 Arguments : none
2450
2451 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2452 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2453 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2454 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2455 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2456
2457 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2458 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2459 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2460 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2461 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2462 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2463 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2464 checked in multiple backends.
2465
2466 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2467 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2468
2469 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2470 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2471 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2472 one fails.
2473
2474 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2475 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2476 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2477
2478 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2479 server's queue.
2480
2481 Example of a header received by the application server :
2482 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2483 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2484
2485 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2486
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002487http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002488 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002489 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2490
2491 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2492 no | yes | yes | yes
2493
2494 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2495 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2496 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002497 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2498 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002499 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2500
2501 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2502 instance.
2503
2504 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002505 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2506 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2507 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002508
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002509 http-request allow if nagios
2510 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2511 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2512 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002513
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002514 Example:
2515 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002516
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002517 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002518
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002519 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2520 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002521
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002522http-send-name-header [<header>]
2523 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2524
2525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2526 yes | no | yes | yes
2527
2528 Arguments :
2529
2530 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2531
2532 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2533 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2534 is added with the header string proved.
2535
2536 See also : "server"
2537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002538id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002539 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2541 no | yes | yes | yes
2542 Arguments : none
2543
2544 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2545 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2546 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002547
2548
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002549ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2550 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2552 no | yes | yes | yes
2553
2554 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2555 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2556 and running).
2557
2558 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2559 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2560 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2561 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2562 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2563
2564 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2565 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2566
2567 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2568 "unless" condition is met.
2569
2570 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2571
2572
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002573log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002574log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002575no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002576 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2578 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002579
2580 Prefix :
2581 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2582 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2583 prefix does not allow arguments.
2584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002585 Arguments :
2586 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2587 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2588 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2589 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2590 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2591 parameter.
2592
2593 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2594 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2595
2596 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2597 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2598 standard syslog port).
2599
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002600 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2601 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2602 standard syslog port).
2603
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002604 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2605 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2606 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2607 appropriately writeable).
2608
2609 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2610
2611 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2612 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2613 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2614
2615 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2616 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2617 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002618 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2619 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2620 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2621 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2622 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002623
2624 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2625
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002626 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2627 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2628 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002629
2630 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2631 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2632 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2633 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2634
2635 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2636 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002637
2638 Example :
2639 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002640 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2641 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002642
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002643log-format <string>
2644 Allows you to custom a log line.
2645
2646 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002648
2649maxconn <conns>
2650 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2652 yes | yes | yes | no
2653 Arguments :
2654 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2655 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2656 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2657 closes.
2658
2659 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2660 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2661 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2662 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2663 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2664 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2665 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2666 properly tuned.
2667
2668 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2669 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2670 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2671
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002672 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2673
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002674 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2675
2676
2677mode { tcp|http|health }
2678 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2680 yes | yes | yes | yes
2681 Arguments :
2682 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2683 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2684 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2685 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2686
2687 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2688 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2689 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2690 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2691 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2692
2693 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002694 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2695 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2696 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2697 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2698 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2699 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2700 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002701
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002702 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2703 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2704 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002705
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002706 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002707 defaults http_instances
2708 mode http
2709
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002710 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002713monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002714 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2716 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002717 Arguments :
2718 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2719 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002720 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2722 backend and its backup.
2723
2724 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2725 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2726 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2727 servers in a list of backends.
2728
2729 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2730 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2731 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2732 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2733 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2734 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2735 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002736 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2737 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738
2739 Example:
2740 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002741 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2743 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2744 monitor-uri /site_alive
2745 monitor fail if site_dead
2746
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002747 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002748
2749
2750monitor-net <source>
2751 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2753 yes | yes | yes | no
2754 Arguments :
2755 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2756 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2757 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2758 followed by a mask.
2759
2760 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2761 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002762 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002763 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2764
2765 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2766 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2767 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2768 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002769 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2770 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2771 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002772
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002773 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2774 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2775 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2776 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2777 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2778 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002779
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002780 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2781 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002782
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002783 Example :
2784 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2785 frontend www
2786 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2787
2788 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2789
2790
2791monitor-uri <uri>
2792 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2794 yes | yes | yes | no
2795 Arguments :
2796 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2797 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2798
2799 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2800 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2801 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2802 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2803 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2804 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2805 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2806 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2807
2808 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2809 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2810 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2811 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2812 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2813 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2814
2815 Example :
2816 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2817 frontend www
2818 mode http
2819 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2820
2821 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002824option abortonclose
2825no option abortonclose
2826 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 yes | no | yes | yes
2829 Arguments : none
2830
2831 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2832 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2833 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2834 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002835 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002836 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2837 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2838 encountered while delivering the response.
2839
2840 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2841 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2842 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2843 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2844 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2845 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002846 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002847 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002848 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002849 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2850 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2851 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2852
2853 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2854 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2855 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2856 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2857 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2858 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2859 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2860 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002861 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002862
2863 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2864 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2865
2866 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2867
2868
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002869option accept-invalid-http-request
2870no option accept-invalid-http-request
2871 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2873 yes | yes | yes | no
2874 Arguments : none
2875
2876 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2877 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2878 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2879 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2880 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2881 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2882 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2883 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002884 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2885 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2886 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2887 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2888 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2889 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002890
2891 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2892 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2893 been confirmed.
2894
2895 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2896 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002897 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2898 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002899 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2900
2901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2903
2904 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2905 stats socket.
2906
2907
2908option accept-invalid-http-response
2909no option accept-invalid-http-response
2910 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2912 yes | no | yes | yes
2913 Arguments : none
2914
2915 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2916 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2917 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2918 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2919 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2920 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2921 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2922 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2923 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2924
2925 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2926 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2927 been confirmed.
2928
2929 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2930 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2931 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2932 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2933
2934 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2935 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2936
2937 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2938 stats socket.
2939
2940
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002941option allbackups
2942no option allbackups
2943 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2945 yes | no | yes | yes
2946 Arguments : none
2947
2948 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2949 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2950 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2951 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2952 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2953 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2954 order between the backup servers anymore.
2955
2956 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2957 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2958
2959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2961
2962
2963option checkcache
2964no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002965 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2967 yes | no | yes | yes
2968 Arguments : none
2969
2970 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2971 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002972 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002973 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2974 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002975 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002976
2977 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002978 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002979 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002980 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2981 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002982 to the client are :
2983 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002984 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002985 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002986 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2987 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2988 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2989 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2990 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2991 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2992 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2993 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2994 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2995 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2996 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2997
2998 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002999 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003000 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003001 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003002 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3003
3004 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3005 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003006 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003007 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3008
3009 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3010 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3011
3012
3013option clitcpka
3014no option clitcpka
3015 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3017 yes | yes | yes | no
3018 Arguments : none
3019
3020 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3021 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3022 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3023 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3024
3025 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3026 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3027 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3028 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3029
3030 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3031 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3032 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3033 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3034 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3035
3036 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3037
3038 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3039 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3040 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3041
3042 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3043 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3044
3045 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3046
3047
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003048option contstats
3049 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3051 yes | yes | yes | no
3052 Arguments : none
3053
3054 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3055 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3056 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3057 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3058 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3059 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3060 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3061
3062
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003063option dontlog-normal
3064no option dontlog-normal
3065 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3067 yes | yes | yes | no
3068 Arguments : none
3069
3070 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3071 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3072 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3073 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3074 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3075 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3076 logged.
3077
3078 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3079 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3080 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003082 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003083 logging.
3084
3085
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003086option dontlognull
3087no option dontlognull
3088 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3090 yes | yes | yes | no
3091 Arguments : none
3092
3093 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3094 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3095 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3096 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3097 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3098 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3099 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3100
3101 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3102 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3103 would not be logged.
3104
3105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003108 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003109
3110
3111option forceclose
3112no option forceclose
3113 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003116 Arguments : none
3117
3118 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3119 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3120 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3121 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3122 global session times in the logs.
3123
3124 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003125 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003126 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3127 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3128 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3129 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003130
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003131 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3132 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3133 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3134
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3137
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003138 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003139
3140
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003141option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003142 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3144 yes | yes | yes | yes
3145 Arguments :
3146 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3147 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003148 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003149 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003150
3151 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3152 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3153 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3154 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3155 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3156 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3157 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003158 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3159 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3160 possible that the client has already brought one.
3161
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003162 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003163 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003164 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3165 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003166 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3167 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003168
3169 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3170 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3171 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3172 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3173 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3174 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3175 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3176
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003177 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3178 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3179 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3180 are under the control of the end-user.
3181
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003182 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003183 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3184 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003185 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3186 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3187 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003188
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003189 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3190 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3191 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3192 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3193 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003194
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003195 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003196 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3197 frontend www
3198 mode http
3199 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3200
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003201 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3202 backend www
3203 mode http
3204 option forwardfor header X-Client
3205
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003206 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3207 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003208
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003209
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003210option http-no-delay
3211no option http-no-delay
3212 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3214 yes | yes | yes | yes
3215 Arguments : none
3216
3217 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3218 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3219 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3220 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3221 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3222 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3223 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3224 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3225 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3226 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3227 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3228 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3229 affected.
3230
3231 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3232 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3233 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3234 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3235 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3236 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3237 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3238 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3239 latency environments.
3240
3241
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003242option http-pretend-keepalive
3243no option http-pretend-keepalive
3244 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3246 yes | yes | yes | yes
3247 Arguments : none
3248
3249 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3250 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3251 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3252 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3253 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3254 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3255 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3256 consider the response complete.
3257
3258 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3259 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3260 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3261 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3262 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3263 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3264
3265 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3266 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3267 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3268 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3269 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3270 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3271 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3272
3273 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3274 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003275 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003276 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3277 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003278
3279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3281
3282 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3283
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003284
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003285option http-server-close
3286no option http-server-close
3287 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3289 yes | yes | yes | yes
3290 Arguments : none
3291
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003292 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3293 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3294 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3295 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3296 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3297 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3298 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3299 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3300 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3301 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3302 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3303 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003304
3305 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3306 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3307 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3308 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003309 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3310 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003311
3312 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3313 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003314 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3315 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3316 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003317
3318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3320
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003321 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3322 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003323
3324
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003325option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003326no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003327 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3329 yes | yes | yes | no
3330 Arguments : none
3331
3332 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3333 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3334 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3335 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3336 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3337 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3338 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3339
3340 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3341 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3342 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3343 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3344 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3345 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3346 request along its whole life.
3347
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003348 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3349 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3350 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3351 front of an existing proxy.
3352
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003353 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3354
3355 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3356 http-server-close".
3357
3358
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003359option httpchk
3360option httpchk <uri>
3361option httpchk <method> <uri>
3362option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3363 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3365 yes | no | yes | yes
3366 Arguments :
3367 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3368 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3369 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3370 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3371 ones.
3372
3373 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3374 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3375 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3376
3377 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3378 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3379 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3380 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3381 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3382
3383 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3384 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3385 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3386 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3387 the lack of any response.
3388
3389 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3390
3391 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3392 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3393 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3394
3395 Examples :
3396 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3397 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3398 backend https_relay
3399 mode tcp
3400 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3401 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3402
3403 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003404 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3405 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003406
3407
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003408option httpclose
3409no option httpclose
3410 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 yes | yes | yes | yes
3413 Arguments : none
3414
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003415 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3416 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3417 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3418 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3419 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3420 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3421 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003422
3423 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003424 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003425 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3426 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3427 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3428 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3429 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003430
3431 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3432 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3433 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003434 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3435 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003436
3437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3439
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003440 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3441 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003442
3443
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003444option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003445 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003448 Arguments :
3449 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3450 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3451 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3452 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3453 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003454
3455 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3456 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3457 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3458 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3459 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3460 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3461 ports.
3462
3463 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3464
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3467 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3468 by default.
3469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003470 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003471
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003472
3473option http_proxy
3474no option http_proxy
3475 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3477 yes | yes | yes | yes
3478 Arguments : none
3479
3480 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3481 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3482 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3483 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3484 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3485
3486 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3487 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3488 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3489 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003490 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003491 be analyzed.
3492
3493 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3494 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3495
3496 Example :
3497 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3498 backend direct_forward
3499 option httpclose
3500 option http_proxy
3501
3502 See also : "option httpclose"
3503
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003504
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003505option independent-streams
3506no option independent-streams
3507 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3509 yes | yes | yes | yes
3510 Arguments : none
3511
3512 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3513 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3514 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3515 receive data or not.
3516
3517 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3518 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3519 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3520 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3521 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3522 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3523 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3524 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3525 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3526 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3527 socket buffers.
3528
3529 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3530 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3531 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3532 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3533 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3534
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003535 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3536 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3537 deprecated.
3538
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003539 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003540
3541
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003542option ldap-check
3543 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3545 yes | no | yes | yes
3546 Arguments : none
3547
3548 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3549 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3550 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3551 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3552
3553 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3554 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3555
3556 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3557 configure it.
3558
3559 Example :
3560 option ldap-check
3561
3562 See also : "option httpchk"
3563
3564
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003565option log-health-checks
3566no option log-health-checks
3567 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3569 yes | no | yes | yes
3570 Arguments : none
3571
3572 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3573 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3574 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3575 of additional information is limited.
3576
3577 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3578 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3579
3580 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3581
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003582
3583option log-separate-errors
3584no option log-separate-errors
3585 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | no
3588 Arguments : none
3589
3590 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3591 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3592 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3593 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3594 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3595 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3596 provides very important information.
3597
3598 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3599 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3600 error logs.
3601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003602 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003603 logging.
3604
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003605
3606option logasap
3607no option logasap
3608 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3610 yes | yes | yes | no
3611 Arguments : none
3612
3613 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3614 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3615 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3616 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3617 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3618 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3619 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003620 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003621 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3622 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3623
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003624 Examples :
3625 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3626 mode http
3627 option httplog
3628 option logasap
3629 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3630
3631 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3632 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3633 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3634 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003636 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003637 logging.
3638
3639
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003640option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3641 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3643 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003644 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003645 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3646 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003647
3648 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3649 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3650 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3651 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3652 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3653 in the MySQL table, like this :
3654
3655 USE mysql;
3656 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3657 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3658
3659 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3660 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3661 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3662 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3663 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3664 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3665 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3666 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3667 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3668
3669 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3670 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003671
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003672 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003673
3674 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3675 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3676 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3677 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3678 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3679 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3680
3681 See also: "option httpchk"
3682
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003683option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3684 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3686 yes | no | yes | yes
3687 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003688 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3689 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003690
3691 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3692 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3693 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3694 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3695
3696 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003697
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003698option nolinger
3699no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003700 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003703 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003704
3705 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3706 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3707 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3708 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3709 connections.
3710
3711 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3712 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3713 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3714 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3715 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3716 this too.
3717
3718 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3719 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3720 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3721
3722 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3723 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3724 for servers.
3725
3726 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3727 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3728
3729
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003730option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3731 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3733 yes | yes | yes | yes
3734 Arguments :
3735 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3736 matching <network>
3737 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3738 header name.
3739
3740 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3741 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3742 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3743 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3744 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3745 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3746 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3747 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3748 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3749 possible that the client has already brought one.
3750
3751 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3752 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3753 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3754 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3755 header and requires different one.
3756
3757 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3758 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3759 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3760 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3761 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3762 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3763 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3764
3765 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3766 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3767 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3768 both are defined.
3769
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003770 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3771 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3772 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3773 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3774 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003775
3776 Examples :
3777 # Original Destination address
3778 frontend www
3779 mode http
3780 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3781
3782 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3783 backend www
3784 mode http
3785 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3786
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003787 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3788 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003789
3790
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003791option persist
3792no option persist
3793 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003796 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003797
3798 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3799 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3800 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3801 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3802 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3803 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3804 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3805 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3806 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3807 redirected to another valid server.
3808
3809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3811
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003812 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003813
3814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003815option redispatch
3816no option redispatch
3817 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003820 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003821
3822 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3823 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3824 be able to access the service anymore.
3825
3826 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3827 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3828
3829 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3830 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3831 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003833 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3834 "redisp" keywords.
3835
3836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3838
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003839 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003840
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003841
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003842option redis-check
3843 Use redis health checks for server testing
3844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | no | yes | yes
3846 Arguments : none
3847
3848 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3849 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3850 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3851 find the "+PONG" response message.
3852
3853 Example :
3854 option redis-check
3855
3856 See also : "option httpchk"
3857
3858
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003859option smtpchk
3860option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3861 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003864 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003865 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3866 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3867 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3868
3869 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3870 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3871 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3872
3873 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3874 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3875 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3876 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3877 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3878 dead server.
3879
3880 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3881 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3882 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3883 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3884
3885 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3886 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3887 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3888 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3889 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3890
3891 Example :
3892 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3893
3894 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003896
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003897option socket-stats
3898no option socket-stats
3899
3900 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3902 yes | yes | yes | no
3903
3904 Arguments : none
3905
3906
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003907option splice-auto
3908no option splice-auto
3909 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | yes | yes | yes
3912 Arguments : none
3913
3914 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3915 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3916 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3917 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003918 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003919 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3920 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3921 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3922 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3923
3924 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3925 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3926 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3927 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3928 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3929 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3930 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3931 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3932 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3933 keyword.
3934
3935 Example :
3936 option splice-auto
3937
3938 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3939 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3940
3941 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3942 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3943
3944
3945option splice-request
3946no option splice-request
3947 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3949 yes | yes | yes | yes
3950 Arguments : none
3951
3952 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003953 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003954 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3955 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3956 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3957 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3958
3959 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3960
3961 Example :
3962 option splice-request
3963
3964 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3965 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3966
3967 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3968 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3969
3970
3971option splice-response
3972no option splice-response
3973 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 yes | yes | yes | yes
3976 Arguments : none
3977
3978 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003979 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003980 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3981 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3982 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3983 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3984
3985 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3986
3987 Example :
3988 option splice-response
3989
3990 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3991 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3992
3993 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3994 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3995
3996
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003997option srvtcpka
3998no option srvtcpka
3999 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4001 yes | no | yes | yes
4002 Arguments : none
4003
4004 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4005 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4006 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4007 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4008
4009 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4010 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4011 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4012 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4013
4014 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4015 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4016 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4017 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4018 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4019
4020 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4021
4022 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4023 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4024 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4025
4026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4028
4029 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4030
4031
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004032option ssl-hello-chk
4033 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4035 yes | no | yes | yes
4036 Arguments : none
4037
4038 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4039 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4040 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4041 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4042 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4043 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4044 hello message.
4045
4046 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4047 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4048 messages, which is appreciable.
4049
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004050 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4051 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4052 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004053
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004054 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4055
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004056
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004057option tcp-smart-accept
4058no option tcp-smart-accept
4059 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4061 yes | yes | yes | no
4062 Arguments : none
4063
4064 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4065 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4066 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4067 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4068 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4069 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4070
4071 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4072 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4073 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4074 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4075
4076 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4077 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4078 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4079 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4080
4081 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4082 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4083 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4084
4085 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4086 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4087 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4088
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004089 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4090
4091
4092option tcp-smart-connect
4093no option tcp-smart-connect
4094 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4096 yes | no | yes | yes
4097 Arguments : none
4098
4099 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4100 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4101 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4102 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4103 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4104
4105 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4106 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4107 complex.
4108
4109 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4110 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4111 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4112
4113 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4114 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4115
4116 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4117
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004118
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004119option tcpka
4120 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 yes | yes | yes | yes
4123 Arguments : none
4124
4125 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4126 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4127 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4128 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4129
4130 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4131 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4132 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4133 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4134
4135 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4136 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4137 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4138 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4139 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4140
4141 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4142
4143 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4144 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4145 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4146 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4147 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4148 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4149 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4150 backends.
4151
4152 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4153
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004154
4155option tcplog
4156 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | yes | yes | yes
4159 Arguments : none
4160
4161 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4162 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4163 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4164 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4165 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4166 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4167 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4168 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4169
4170 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004172 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004173
4174
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004175option transparent
4176no option transparent
4177 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004179 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004180 Arguments : none
4181
4182 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4183 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4184 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4185 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4186 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4187 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4188 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4189 appropriate server.
4190
4191 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4192 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4193
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004194 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004195 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004196
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004197
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004198persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004199persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004200 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4202 yes | no | yes | yes
4203 Arguments :
4204 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004205 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4206 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004207
4208 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4209 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4210 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4211 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4212 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4213 forwarded to this server.
4214
4215 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4216 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4217 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004218 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004219 a single "listen" section.
4220
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004221 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4222 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4223 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4224
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004225 Example :
4226 listen tse-farm
4227 bind :3389
4228 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4229 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4230 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4231 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4232 persist rdp-cookie
4233 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004234 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004235 balance rdp-cookie
4236 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4237 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4238
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004239 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4240 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004241
4242
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004243rate-limit sessions <rate>
4244 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4246 yes | yes | yes | no
4247 Arguments :
4248 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4249 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4250
4251 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4252 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4253 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4254 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4255 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4256 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4257
4258 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4259 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4260 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4261 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4262
4263 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4264 listen smtp
4265 mode tcp
4266 bind :25
4267 rate-limit sessions 10
4268 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4269
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004270 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4271 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4272 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004273
4274 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4275
4276
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004277redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4278redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4279redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004280 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4282 no | yes | yes | yes
4283
4284 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004285 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004286
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004287 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004288 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4289 the HTTP "Location" header.
4290
4291 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4292 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4293 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4294 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4295 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4296 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4297
4298 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4299 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4300 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4301 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4302 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4303 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4304 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4305 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4306 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004307
4308 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4309 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4310 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4311 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4312 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4313 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4314 location with a GET method.
4315
4316 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4317 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4318
4319 - "drop-query"
4320 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4321 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4322 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4323 with a location-type redirect.
4324
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004325 - "append-slash"
4326 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4327 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4328 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4329 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4330
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004331 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4332 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4333 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4334 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4335 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4336 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4337 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4338
4339 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4340 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4341 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4342 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4343 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4344 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4345 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004346
4347 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4348 acl clear dst_port 80
4349 acl secure dst_port 8080
4350 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004351 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004352 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004353 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4354
4355 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004356 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4357 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4358 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004359 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004360
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004361 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4362 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4363 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4364
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004365 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004366 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004368 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004369
4370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004371redisp (deprecated)
4372redispatch (deprecated)
4373 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4374 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4375 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004376 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004377
4378 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4379 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4380 be able to access the service anymore.
4381
4382 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4383 redistribute them to a working server.
4384
4385 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4386 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4387 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004389 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4390 "option redispatch" instead.
4391
4392 See also : "option redispatch"
4393
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004394
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004395reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004396 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4398 no | yes | yes | yes
4399 Arguments :
4400 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4401 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004402 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004403
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004404 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4405 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4406
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004407 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4408 the last header of an HTTP request.
4409
4410 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4411 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4412 responses.
4413
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004414 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4415 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4416 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4417
4418 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4419 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004420
4421
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004422reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4423reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004424 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4426 no | yes | yes | yes
4427 Arguments :
4428 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4429 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4430 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4431 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4432 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4433 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4434 ignores case.
4435
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004436 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4437 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4438
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004439 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4440 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4441 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4442 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004443 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004444
4445 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4446 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4447
4448 Example :
4449 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4450 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4451 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4452
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004453 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4454 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004455
4456
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004457reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4458reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004459 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 no | yes | yes | yes
4462 Arguments :
4463 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4464 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4465 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4466 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4467 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4468 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4469
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004470 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4471 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4472
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004473 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4474 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4475 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4476 next servers.
4477
4478 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4479 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4480 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4481
4482 Example :
4483 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4484 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4485 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4486
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004487 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4488 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004489
4490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004491reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4492reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004493 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4495 no | yes | yes | yes
4496 Arguments :
4497 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4498 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4499 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4500 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4501 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4502 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4503 case.
4504
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004505 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4506 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4507
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004508 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4509 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4510 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4511 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004512 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004513
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004514 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004515 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004516 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004517
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004518 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4519 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4520
4521 Example :
4522 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4523 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4524 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4525
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004526 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4527 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004528
4529
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004530reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4531reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004532 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4534 no | yes | yes | yes
4535 Arguments :
4536 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4537 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4538 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4539 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4540 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4541 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4542 case.
4543
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004544 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4545 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4546
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004547 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4548 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4549 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4550 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4551
4552 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4553 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4554
4555 Example :
4556 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4557 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4558 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4559 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4560
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004561 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4562 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004563
4564
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004565reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4566reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004567 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4569 no | yes | yes | yes
4570 Arguments :
4571 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4572 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4573 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4574 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4575 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4576 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4577
4578 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4579 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4580 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4581 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004582 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004583
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004584 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4585 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4586
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004587 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4588 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4589 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4590
4591 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4592 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4593 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4594 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4595 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4596
4597 Example :
4598 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004599 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004600 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4601 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4602
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004603 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4604 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004605
4606
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004607reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4608reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004609 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 no | yes | yes | yes
4612 Arguments :
4613 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4614 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4615 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4616 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4617 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4618 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4619 ignores case.
4620
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004621 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4622 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4623
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004624 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4625 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004626 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4627 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4628 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004629 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4630 not set.
4631
4632 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4633 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4634 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4635 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4636 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4637
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004638 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004639 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4640 # block all others.
4641 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4642 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4643
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004644 # block bad guys
4645 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4646 reqitarpit . if badguys
4647
4648 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4649 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004650
4651
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004652retries <value>
4653 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4655 yes | no | yes | yes
4656 Arguments :
4657 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4658 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4659 default value is 3.
4660
4661 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4662 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4663 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4664
4665 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4666 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4667
4668 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4669 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4670
4671 See also : "option redispatch"
4672
4673
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004674rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004675 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 no | yes | yes | yes
4678 Arguments :
4679 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4680 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004681 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004682
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004683 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4684 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4685
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004686 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4687 the last header of an HTTP response.
4688
4689 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4690 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4691 responses.
4692
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004693 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4694 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004695
4696
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004697rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4698rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004699 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 no | yes | yes | yes
4702 Arguments :
4703 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4704 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4705 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4706 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4707 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4708 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4709 ignores case.
4710
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004711 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4712 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4713
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004714 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4715 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004716 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004717 client.
4718
4719 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4720 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4721 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4722
4723 Example :
4724 # remove the Server header from responses
4725 reqidel ^Server:.*
4726
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004727 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4728 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004729
4730
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004731rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4732rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004733 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 no | yes | yes | yes
4736 Arguments :
4737 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4738 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4739 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4740 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4741 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4742 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4743 ignores case.
4744
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004745 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4746 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4747
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004748 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4749 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4750 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4751 case-sensitive.
4752
4753 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004754 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4755 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4756 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004757
4758 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4759 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4760
4761 Example :
4762 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4763 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4764
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004765 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4766 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004767
4768
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004769rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4770rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004771 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 no | yes | yes | yes
4774 Arguments :
4775 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4776 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4777 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4778 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4779 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4780 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4781 ignores case.
4782
4783 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4784 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4785 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4786 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004787 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004788
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004789 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4790 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4791
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004792 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4793 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4794 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4795
4796 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4797 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4798 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4799 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4800 are not case-sensitive.
4801
4802 Example :
4803 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4804 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4805
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004806 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4807 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004808
4809
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004810server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004811 Declare a server in a backend
4812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 no | no | yes | yes
4814 Arguments :
4815 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004816 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004817 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004818
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004819 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4820 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4821 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4822 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004823 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4824 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4825 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4826 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4827 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4828 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004829
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004830 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004831 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4832 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4833 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4834 adding this value to the client's port.
4835
4836 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4837 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004838 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004839
4840 Examples :
4841 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4842 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4843
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004844 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4845 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004846
4847
4848source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004849source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004850source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004851 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4853 yes | no | yes | yes
4854 Arguments :
4855 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4856 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4857 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4858 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4859
4860 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4861 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004862 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4863 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4864 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004865
4866 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4867 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4868 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4869 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4870 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4871 <addr>.
4872
4873 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4874 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4875 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4876 port.
4877
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004878 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4879 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4880 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4881 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4882 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4883 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4884 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4885 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4886 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4887 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4888 HTTP header.
4889
4890 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4891 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004892 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004893 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4894 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4895 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4896 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4897 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4898 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4899 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4900
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004901 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4902 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4903 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4904 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4905 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4906 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4907
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004908 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4909 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4910 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4911 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4912
4913 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4914 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4915 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4916 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4917 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4918 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4919
4920 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4921 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4922 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4923 there are two methods :
4924
4925 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4926 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4927 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4928 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4929 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4930 of the client ranges may be used.
4931
4932 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4933 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4934 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4935 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4936 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4937 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4938 same session.
4939
4940 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4941 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4942 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4943 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4944 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4945 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4946
4947 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4948 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4949 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004950 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004951
4952 Examples :
4953 backend private
4954 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4955 source 192.168.1.200
4956
4957 backend transparent_ssl1
4958 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4959 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4960
4961 backend transparent_ssl2
4962 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4963 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4964 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4965
4966 backend transparent_ssl3
4967 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4968 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4969 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4970
4971 backend transparent_smtp
4972 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4973 # with Tproxy version 4.
4974 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4975
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004976 backend transparent_http
4977 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4978 # proxy.
4979 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004981 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004982 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004984
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004985srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4986 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4988 yes | no | yes | yes
4989 Arguments :
4990 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4991 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4992 as explained at the top of this document.
4993
4994 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4995 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4996 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4997 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4998 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4999 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5000 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5001
5002 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5003 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5004 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5005 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5006 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005007 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005008 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005009 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005010
5011 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5012 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5013 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5014 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5015 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5016 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5017
5018 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5019 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5020
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005021 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5022 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005023
5024
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005025stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5026 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5028 no | no | yes | yes
5029
5030 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5031 matched.
5032
5033 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5034 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5035
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005036 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5037 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5038 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5039
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005040 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5041 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5042 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5043 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005044
5045 Example :
5046 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5047 backend stats_localhost
5048 stats enable
5049 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5050
5051 Example :
5052 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5053 backend stats_auth
5054 stats enable
5055 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5056 stats admin if TRUE
5057
5058 Example :
5059 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5060 userlist stats-auth
5061 group admin users admin
5062 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5063 group readonly users haproxy
5064 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5065
5066 backend stats_auth
5067 stats enable
5068 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5069 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5070 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5071 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5072
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005073 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5074 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5075 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005076
5077
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005078stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5079 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5081 yes | no | yes | yes
5082 Arguments :
5083 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5084
5085 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5086
5087 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5088 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5089 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5090 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5091 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5092 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5093
5094 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5095 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5096 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005097 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005098
5099 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5100 report using "stats scope".
5101
5102 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5103 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5104 unobvious parameters.
5105
5106 Example :
5107 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5108 backend public_www
5109 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5110 stats enable
5111 stats hide-version
5112 stats scope .
5113 stats uri /admin?stats
5114 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5115 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5116 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5117
5118 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5119 backend private_monitoring
5120 stats enable
5121 stats uri /admin?stats
5122 stats refresh 5s
5123
5124 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5125
5126
5127stats enable
5128 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5130 yes | no | yes | yes
5131 Arguments : none
5132
5133 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5134 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5135 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5136 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5137 - stats auth : no authentication
5138 - stats scope : no restriction
5139
5140 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5141 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5142 unobvious parameters.
5143
5144 Example :
5145 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5146 backend public_www
5147 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5148 stats enable
5149 stats hide-version
5150 stats scope .
5151 stats uri /admin?stats
5152 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5153 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5154 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5155
5156 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5157 backend private_monitoring
5158 stats enable
5159 stats uri /admin?stats
5160 stats refresh 5s
5161
5162 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5163
5164
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005165stats hide-version
5166 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5168 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005169 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005170
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005171 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5172 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5173 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5174 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5175 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5176 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005178 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5179 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5180 unobvious parameters.
5181
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005182 Example :
5183 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5184 backend public_www
5185 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005186 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005187 stats hide-version
5188 stats scope .
5189 stats uri /admin?stats
5190 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5191 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5192 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005193
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005194 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5195 backend private_monitoring
5196 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005197 stats uri /admin?stats
5198 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005199
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005200 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005201
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005202
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005203stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5204 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5205 Access control for statistics
5206
5207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5208 no | no | yes | yes
5209
5210 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5211 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5212 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5213 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5214 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5215 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5216
5217 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5218 instance.
5219
5220 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5221 about ACL usage.
5222
5223
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005224stats realm <realm>
5225 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5227 yes | no | yes | yes
5228 Arguments :
5229 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5230 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5231 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5232
5233 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5234 using a backslash ('\').
5235
5236 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5237 only related to authentication.
5238
5239 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5240 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5241 unobvious parameters.
5242
5243 Example :
5244 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5245 backend public_www
5246 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5247 stats enable
5248 stats hide-version
5249 stats scope .
5250 stats uri /admin?stats
5251 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5252 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5253 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5254
5255 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5256 backend private_monitoring
5257 stats enable
5258 stats uri /admin?stats
5259 stats refresh 5s
5260
5261 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5262
5263
5264stats refresh <delay>
5265 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5267 yes | no | yes | yes
5268 Arguments :
5269 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5270 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5271 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5272 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5273 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5274 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5275
5276 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5277 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5278 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5279 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5280
5281 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5282 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5283 unobvious parameters.
5284
5285 Example :
5286 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5287 backend public_www
5288 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5289 stats enable
5290 stats hide-version
5291 stats scope .
5292 stats uri /admin?stats
5293 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5294 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5295 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5296
5297 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5298 backend private_monitoring
5299 stats enable
5300 stats uri /admin?stats
5301 stats refresh 5s
5302
5303 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5304
5305
5306stats scope { <name> | "." }
5307 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5309 yes | no | yes | yes
5310 Arguments :
5311 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5312 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5313 section in which the statement appears.
5314
5315 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5316 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5317 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5318 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5319 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5320 exists.
5321
5322 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5323 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5324 unobvious parameters.
5325
5326 Example :
5327 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5328 backend public_www
5329 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5330 stats enable
5331 stats hide-version
5332 stats scope .
5333 stats uri /admin?stats
5334 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5335 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5336 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5337
5338 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5339 backend private_monitoring
5340 stats enable
5341 stats uri /admin?stats
5342 stats refresh 5s
5343
5344 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5345
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005346
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005347stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005348 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5350 yes | no | yes | yes
5351
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005352 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005353 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5354
5355 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5356 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5357
5358 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5359 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005360 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005361
5362 Example :
5363 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5364 backend private_monitoring
5365 stats enable
5366 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5367 stats uri /admin?stats
5368 stats refresh 5s
5369
5370 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5371 global section.
5372
5373
5374stats show-legends
5375 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5376 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5377 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5378 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5379 - IP (socket, server)
5380 - cookie (backend, server)
5381
5382 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5383 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005384 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005385
5386 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5387
5388
5389stats show-node [ <name> ]
5390 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5392 yes | no | yes | yes
5393 Arguments:
5394 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5395 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5396
5397 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5398 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005399 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005400
5401 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5402 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5403 unobvious parameters.
5404
5405 Example:
5406 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5407 backend private_monitoring
5408 stats enable
5409 stats show-node Europe-1
5410 stats uri /admin?stats
5411 stats refresh 5s
5412
5413 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5414 section.
5415
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005416
5417stats uri <prefix>
5418 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5420 yes | no | yes | yes
5421 Arguments :
5422 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5423 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5424 query string.
5425
5426 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5427 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5428 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5429 possible to reach it in the application.
5430
5431 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005432 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005433 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5434 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5435 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5436 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5437
5438 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5439 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5440 an address or a port to statistics only.
5441
5442 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5443 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5444 unobvious parameters.
5445
5446 Example :
5447 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5448 backend public_www
5449 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5450 stats enable
5451 stats hide-version
5452 stats scope .
5453 stats uri /admin?stats
5454 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5455 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5456 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5457
5458 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5459 backend private_monitoring
5460 stats enable
5461 stats uri /admin?stats
5462 stats refresh 5s
5463
5464 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5465
5466
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005467stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5468 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005470 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005471
5472 Arguments :
5473 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5474 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5475 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5476 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5477
5478 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5479 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5480 the "stick-table" statement.
5481
5482 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5483 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5484 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5485 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5486 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5487
5488 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5489 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5490 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5491 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5492 transformation rules.
5493
5494 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5495 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5496 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5497 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5498 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5499 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5500 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5501
5502 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5503 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5504 ACL based conditions.
5505
5506 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5507 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5508 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5509 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5510
5511 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5512 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5513 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5514 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5515
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005516 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5517 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5518 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5519
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005520 Example :
5521 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5522 # last 30 minutes
5523 backend pop
5524 mode tcp
5525 balance roundrobin
5526 stick store-request src
5527 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5528 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5529 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5530
5531 backend smtp
5532 mode tcp
5533 balance roundrobin
5534 stick match src table pop
5535 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5536 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005538 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5539 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005540
5541
5542stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5543 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5545 no | no | yes | yes
5546
5547 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5548 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5549 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5550 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5551
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005552 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5553 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5554 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5555
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005556 Examples :
5557 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005558 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005559
5560 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5561 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5562 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5563
5564
5565 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5566 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5567 backend http
5568 mode http
5569 balance roundrobin
5570 stick on src table https
5571 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5572 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5573 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5574
5575 backend https
5576 mode tcp
5577 balance roundrobin
5578 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5579 stick on src
5580 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5581 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5582
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005583 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005584
5585
5586stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5587 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 no | no | yes | yes
5590
5591 Arguments :
5592 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5593 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5594 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5595 server is selected.
5596
5597 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5598 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5599 the "stick-table" statement.
5600
5601 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5602 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5603 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5604 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5605 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5606 address.
5607
5608 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5609 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5610 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5611 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5612 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5613 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5614 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5615 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5616 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5617 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5618
5619 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5620 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5621 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5622 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5623 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5624 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5625 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5626
5627 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5628 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5629 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5630 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5631
5632 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5633 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5634 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5635 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5636 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5637 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5638 another protocol or access method.
5639
5640 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5641 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5642 the request.
5643
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005644 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5645 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5646 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5647
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005648 Example :
5649 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5650 # last 30 minutes
5651 backend pop
5652 mode tcp
5653 balance roundrobin
5654 stick store-request src
5655 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5656 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5657 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5658
5659 backend smtp
5660 mode tcp
5661 balance roundrobin
5662 stick match src table pop
5663 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5664 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5665
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005666 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5667 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005668
5669
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005670stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005671 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5672 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005673 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005675 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005676
5677 Arguments :
5678 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5679 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5680 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5681 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5682
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005683 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5684 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5685 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5686 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5687
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005688 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5689 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5690 instance.
5691
5692 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5693 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5694 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5695 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5696 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5697 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005698 to 32 characters.
5699
5700 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5701 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5702 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5703 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5704 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5705 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005706
5707 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005708 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5709 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005710 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5711 increase.
5712
5713 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005714 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5715 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5716 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005717
5718 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5719 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5720 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5721 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5722 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5723 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5724 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5725 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5726 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5727 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5728 parameter (see below).
5729
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005730 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5731 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5732 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5733 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5734 soft restart.
5735
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005736 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5737
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005738 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5739 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5740 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5741 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5742 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005743 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005744 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5745 if not expiration delay is specified.
5746
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005747 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5748 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5749 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5750 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005751 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5752 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5753 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5754 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5755 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5756 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5757 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5758 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5759 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5760 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5761 types and their arguments.
5762
5763 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5764 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5765 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5766 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5767
5768 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5769 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5770 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5771 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5772
5773 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5774 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5775 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5776 they were received.
5777
5778 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5779 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5780 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5781 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5782 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5783
5784 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5785 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5786 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5787 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5788 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5789
5790 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5791 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5792 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5793
5794 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5795 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5796 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5797 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5798 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5799
5800 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5801 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5802 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5803 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5804 the client side.
5805
5806 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5807 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5808 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5809 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5810 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5811 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5812 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5813
5814 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5815 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5816 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5817 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5818 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5819 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5820 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5821
5822 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5823 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5824 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5825 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5826 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5827 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5828
5829 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5830 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5831 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5832 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5833
5834 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5835 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5836 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5837 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5838 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5839 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5840 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5841 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5842 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5843 recommended for better fairness.
5844
5845 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5846 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5847 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5848 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5849
5850 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5851 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5852 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5853 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5854 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5855 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5856 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5857 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5858 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5859 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005860
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005861 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5862 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005863 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5864 reference it.
5865
5866 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5867 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5868 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5869 as an exclusive stickiness.
5870
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005871 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5872 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5873 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5874 something that can be ignored.
5875
5876 Example:
5877 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5878 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5879 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5880 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5881
5882 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005883 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005884
5885
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005886stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5887 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5889 no | no | yes | yes
5890
5891 Arguments :
5892 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5893 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5894 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5895 server is selected.
5896
5897 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5898 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5899 the "stick-table" statement.
5900
5901 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5902 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5903 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5904 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5905
5906 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5907 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5908 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5909 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5910 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5911 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005912 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005913 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5914 rules.
5915
5916 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5917 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5918 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5919 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5920 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5921 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5922 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5923
5924 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5925 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5926 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5927 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5928
5929 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5930 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5931 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5932 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5933 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5934 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5935 another protocol or access method.
5936
5937 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5938
5939 Example :
5940 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5941 backend https
5942 mode tcp
5943 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005944 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005945 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005946
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005947 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5948 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5949
5950 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5951 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5952 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5953
5954 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5955 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005956
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005957 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5958 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5959 # at offset 44.
5960
5961 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5962 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5963
5964 # Learn on response if server hello.
5965 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005966
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005967 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5968 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5969
5970 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5971 extraction.
5972
5973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005974tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5975 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5977 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005978 Arguments :
5979 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5980 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5981 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005982
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005983 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005984
5985 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5986 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005987 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5988 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5989 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5990 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5991 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5992 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005994 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5995 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5996 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5997 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005999 Three types of actions are supported :
6000 - accept :
6001 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6002 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6003 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006005 - reject :
6006 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6007 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6008 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6009 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6010 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6011 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6012 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6013 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6014 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6015 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6016 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6017 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006019 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6020 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6021 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6022 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6023 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6024 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6025 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6026 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6027 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006029 These actions take one or two arguments :
6030 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6031 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6032 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006034 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6035 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6036 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6037 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006038
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006039 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6040 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6041 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6042 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6043 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6044 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6045 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6046 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6047 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6048 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006050 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6051 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6052 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006054 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6055 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6056 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006058 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006059 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006060 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006062 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6063 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6064 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006066 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6067 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6068 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006069
6070 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006072 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006073
6074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006075tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6076 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006078 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006079 Arguments :
6080 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6081 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6082 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006083
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006084 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006086 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6087 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6088 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6089 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6090 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006092 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6093 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6094 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6095 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6096 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6097 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6098 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6099 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6100 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006102 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6103 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6104 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6105 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006107 Three types of actions are supported :
6108 - accept :
6109 - reject :
6110 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006112 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6113 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006114
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006115 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6116 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6117 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6118 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6119 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6120 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006122 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006123 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6124 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006126 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006127 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6128 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6129 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6130 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6131 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006132
6133 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006134 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6135 # and reject everything else.
6136 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6137 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006138 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006139 tcp-request content reject
6140
6141 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006142 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6143 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6144 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006145 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006146
6147 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6148 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6149 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006150 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006151 tcp-request content reject
6152
6153 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6154 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6155
6156 frontend http
6157 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6158 # protecting all our sites
6159 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6160 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6161 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6162 ...
6163 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6164
6165 backend http_dynamic
6166 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6167 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6168 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6169 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6170 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6171 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6172 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006174 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006175
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006176 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006177
6178
6179tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6180 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006182 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006183 Arguments :
6184 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6185 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6186 as explained at the top of this document.
6187
6188 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6189 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6190 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6191 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6192 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6193
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006194 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6195 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6196 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6197 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6198
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006199 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6200 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006201 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006202 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006203 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6204 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6205 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6206 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006207
6208 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6209 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6210 it pass through unaffected.
6211
6212 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6213 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6214 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006215 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006216 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6217 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006218 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6219 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6220 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006221
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006222 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006223 "timeout client".
6224
6225
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006226tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6227 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6229 no | no | yes | yes
6230 Arguments :
6231 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6232 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6233 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6234
6235 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6236
6237 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6238 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6239 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6240 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006241 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006242
6243 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6244
6245 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6246 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6247 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6248 inserted.
6249
6250 Two types of actions are supported :
6251 - accept :
6252 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6253 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6254 the rules evaluation.
6255
6256 - reject :
6257 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6258 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006259 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006260
6261 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6262 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6263 for changing the default action to a reject.
6264
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006265 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6266 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6267 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6268 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006269 period.
6270
6271 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6272
6273 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6274
6275
6276tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6277 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 no | no | yes | yes
6280 Arguments :
6281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6283 as explained at the top of this document.
6284
6285 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6286
6287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006288timeout check <timeout>
6289 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6290 established.
6291
6292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | no | yes | yes
6294 Arguments:
6295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6297 as explained at the top of this document.
6298
6299 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6300 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6301 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6302 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006303 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6304 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6305 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006306
6307 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6308 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6309
6310 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6311 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006312 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006313
6314 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6315 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6316 forget about it.
6317
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006318 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6319 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006320
6321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006322timeout client <timeout>
6323timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6324 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6326 yes | yes | yes | no
6327 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006328 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006329 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6330 as explained at the top of this document.
6331
6332 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6333 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6334 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6335 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6336 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6337 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6338 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6339 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006340 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006341 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006342 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6343 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6344 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006345
6346 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6347 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6348 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6349 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6350 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6351 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6352
6353 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6354 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6355 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6356
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006357 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006358
6359
6360timeout connect <timeout>
6361timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6362 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6364 yes | no | yes | yes
6365 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006366 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006367 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6368 as explained at the top of this document.
6369
6370 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006371 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006372 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006373 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006374 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6375 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006376
6377 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6378 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6379 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6380 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6381 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6382 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6383
6384 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6385 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6386 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6387
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006388 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6389 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006390
6391
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006392timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6393 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | yes | yes | yes
6396 Arguments :
6397 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6398 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6399 as explained at the top of this document.
6400
6401 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6402 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6403 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6404 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6405 once the request has started to present itself.
6406
6407 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6408 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6409 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6410 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6411 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6412
6413 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6414 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6415 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6416 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6417
6418 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6419 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6420 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6421 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6422 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006423 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006424
6425 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6426 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6427 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6428 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6429
6430 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6431
6432
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006433timeout http-request <timeout>
6434 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006436 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006437 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006438 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006439 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6440 as explained at the top of this document.
6441
6442 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6443 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6444 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6445 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6446 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6447 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6448 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6449 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6450
6451 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6452 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006453 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6454 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006455
6456 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6457 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6458 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6459 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6460 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6461
6462 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006463 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6464 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6465 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006466
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006467 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006468
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006469
6470timeout queue <timeout>
6471 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6473 yes | no | yes | yes
6474 Arguments :
6475 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6476 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6477 as explained at the top of this document.
6478
6479 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6480 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6481 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6482 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6483 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6484
6485 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6486 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6487 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6488 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6489
6490 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6491
6492
6493timeout server <timeout>
6494timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6495 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6497 yes | no | yes | yes
6498 Arguments :
6499 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6500 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6501 as explained at the top of this document.
6502
6503 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6504 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6505 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6506 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6507 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6508 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6509 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6510
6511 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6512 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6513 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6514 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6515 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006516 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006517 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006518 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6519 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6520 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6521 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006522
6523 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6524 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6525 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6526 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6527 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6528 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6529
6530 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6531 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6532 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6533
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006534 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006535
6536
6537timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006538 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6540 yes | yes | yes | yes
6541 Arguments :
6542 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6543 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6544 as explained at the top of this document.
6545
6546 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6547 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6548 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6549
6550 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6551 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6552 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6553 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006554 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006555
6556 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6557
6558
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006559timeout tunnel <timeout>
6560 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6562 yes | no | yes | yes
6563 Arguments :
6564 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6565 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6566 as explained at the top of this document.
6567
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006568 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006569 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6570 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6571 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6572 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6573 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6574 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6575 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6576 specified.
6577
6578 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6579 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6580 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6581 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6582 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6583
6584 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6585 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6586 forget about it.
6587
6588 Example :
6589 defaults http
6590 option http-server-close
6591 timeout connect 5s
6592 timeout client 30s
6593 timeout client 30s
6594 timeout server 30s
6595 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6596
6597 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6598
6599
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006600transparent (deprecated)
6601 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006603 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006604 Arguments : none
6605
6606 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6607 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6608 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6609 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6610 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6611 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6612 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6613 appropriate server.
6614
6615 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6616
6617 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6618 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6619
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006620 See also: "option transparent"
6621
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006622unique-id-format <string>
6623 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6625 yes | yes | yes | no
6626 Arguments :
6627 <string> is a log-format string.
6628
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006629 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6630 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6631 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6632 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006633
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006634 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6635 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6636 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6637 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6638 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6639 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6640 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6641 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006642
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006643 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6644 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006645
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006646 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006647
6648 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6649
6650 will generate:
6651
6652 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6653
6654 See also: "unique-id-header"
6655
6656unique-id-header <name>
6657 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6659 yes | yes | yes | no
6660 Arguments :
6661 <name> is the name of the header.
6662
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006663 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6664 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006665
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006666 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006667
6668 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6669 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6670
6671 will generate:
6672
6673 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6674
6675 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006676
6677use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6678use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006679 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6681 no | yes | yes | no
6682 Arguments :
6683 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006685 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006686
6687 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6688 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6689 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006690 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6691 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6692 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6693 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006694
6695 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6696 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6697 assign the backend.
6698
6699 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6700 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6701 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6702 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6703 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6704 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6705
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006706 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006707 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006708 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6709 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6710 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6711
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006712 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006713
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006714
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006715use-server <server> if <condition>
6716use-server <server> unless <condition>
6717 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6719 no | no | yes | yes
6720 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006721 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006722
6723 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6724
6725 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6726 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6727 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6728
6729 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6730 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6731 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6732 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6733 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6734 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6735 matches will assign the server.
6736
6737 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6738 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6739 with the next rules until one matches.
6740
6741 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6742 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6743 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6744 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6745
6746 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6747 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6748 stripped.
6749
6750 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6751 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6752 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6753 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6754
6755 Example :
6756 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6757 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6758 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6759 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6760 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6761 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6762 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6763 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6764 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6765
6766 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6767
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006768
67695. Bind and Server options
6770--------------------------
6771
6772The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6773depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6774settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6775written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6776described in this section.
6777
6778
67795.1. Bind options
6780-----------------
6781
6782The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6783as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6784no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6785parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6786while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6787provided immediately after the setting name.
6788
6789The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6790
6791accept-proxy
6792 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6793 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6794 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6795 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6796 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6797 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6798 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6799 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6800 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6801 usable.
6802
6803backlog <backlog>
6804 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6805 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6806
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006807ecdhe <named curve>
6808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6809 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6810 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6811
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006812ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6814 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6815 client's certificate.
6816
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006817ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6819 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6820 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6821 error is ignored.
6822
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006823ciphers <ciphers>
6824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6825 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6826 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6827 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6828 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6829
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006830crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6832 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6833 to verify client's certificate.
6834
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006835crt <cert>
6836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6837 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6838 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006839 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6840 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6841 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6842 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6843 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6844 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6845 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6846 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006847 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006848 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6849 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6850 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6851 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6852 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006853
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006854crt-ignore-err <errors>
6855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6856 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6857 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6858 error is ignored.
6859
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006860defer-accept
6861 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6862 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6863 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6864 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6865 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6866 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6867 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6868 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6869 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6870 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6871 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6872
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006873force-sslv3
6874 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6875 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6876 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6877
6878force-tlsv10
6879 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6880 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6881
6882force-tlsv11
6883 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6884 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6885
6886force-tlsv12
6887 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6888 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6889
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006890gid <gid>
6891 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6892 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6893 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6894 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6895 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6896
6897group <group>
6898 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6899 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6900 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6901 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6902 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6903
6904id <id>
6905 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6906 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6907 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6908 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6909
6910interface <interface>
6911 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6912 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6913 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6914 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6915 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6916 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6917 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6918 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6919
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006920level <level>
6921 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6922 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6923 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6924 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6925 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6926 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6927 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6928 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6929 counters).
6930 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6931 all counters).
6932
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006933maxconn <maxconn>
6934 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6935 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6936 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6937 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6938 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6939 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6940 eat all memory.
6941
6942mode <mode>
6943 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6944 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6945 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6946 UNIX sockets.
6947
6948mss <maxseg>
6949 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6950 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6951 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6952 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6953 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6954 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6955 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6956 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6957 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6958 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6959 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6960
6961name <name>
6962 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6963 page.
6964
6965nice <nice>
6966 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
6967 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
6968 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
6969 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
6970 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
6971 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
6972 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
6973 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
6974 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
6975 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
6976 one for an RDP socket.
6977
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006978no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6980 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6981 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006982 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6983 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006984
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02006985no-tls-tickets
6986 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6987 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
6988 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
6989 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
6990
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006991no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006992 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006993 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6994 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6995 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6996 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006997
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006998no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007000 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7001 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7002 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7003 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007004
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007005no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007007 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7008 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7009 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7010 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007011
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007012npn <protocols>
7013 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7014 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7015 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7016 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7017 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7018
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007019ssl
7020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7021 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7022 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7023 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7024 to deciphered contents.
7025
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007026tfo
7027 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7028 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7029 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7030 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7031 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7032 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7033 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7034 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7035 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7036
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007037transparent
7038 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7039 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7040 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7041 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7042 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7043 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7044 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7045 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7046 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7047 so check for support with your vendor.
7048
7049uid <uid>
7050 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7051 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7052 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7053 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7054 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7055
7056user <user>
7057 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7058 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7059 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7060 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7061 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7062
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007063verify [none|optional|required]
7064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7065 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7066 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7067 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7068 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007069 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7070 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7071 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7072 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007073
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020070745.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007075------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007077The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7078which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7079arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7080settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7081after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7082Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7083address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007085 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007086 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007088The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007089
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007090addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007091 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7092 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7093 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7094 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7095 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007097 Supported in default-server: No
7098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007099backup
7100 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7101 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7102 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7103 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7104 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7105 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007107 Supported in default-server: No
7108
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007109ca-file <cafile>
7110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7111 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7112 server's certificate.
7113
7114 Supported in default-server: No
7115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007116check
7117 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007118 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7119 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7120 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7121 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7122 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7123 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7124 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7125 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7126 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7127 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007128
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007129 Supported in default-server: No
7130
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007131check-send-proxy
7132 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7133 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7134 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7135 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7136 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7137 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7138 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7139
7140 Supported in default-server: No
7141
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007142check-ssl
7143 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7144 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7145 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7146 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7147 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7148 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7149 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7150 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7151 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7152
7153 Supported in default-server: No
7154
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007155ciphers <ciphers>
7156 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7157 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7158 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7159 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7160 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7161 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7162 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7163 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7164
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007165 Supported in default-server: No
7166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007167cookie <value>
7168 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7169 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7170 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7171 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7172 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7173 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7174 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007176 Supported in default-server: No
7177
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007178crl-file <crlfile>
7179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7180 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7181 to verify server's certificate.
7182
7183 Supported in default-server: No
7184
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007185crt <cert>
7186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7187 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7188 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7189 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7190 certificate request.
7191
7192 Supported in default-server: No
7193
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007194disabled
7195 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7196 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7197 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7198 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7199 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7200
7201 Supported in default-server: No
7202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007203error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007204 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7205 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7206 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007208 Supported in default-server: Yes
7209
7210 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007212fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7214 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7215 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007217 Supported in default-server: Yes
7218
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007219force-sslv3
7220 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7221 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7222 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7223
7224 Supported in default-server: No
7225
7226force-tlsv10
7227 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7228 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7229
7230 Supported in default-server: No
7231
7232force-tlsv11
7233 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7234 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7235
7236 Supported in default-server: No
7237
7238force-tlsv12
7239 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7240 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7241
7242 Supported in default-server: No
7243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007244id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007245 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7246 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7247 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007249 Supported in default-server: No
7250
7251inter <delay>
7252fastinter <delay>
7253downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007254 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7255 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7256 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7257 between checks depending on the server state :
7258
7259 Server state | Interval used
7260 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7261 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7262 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7263 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7264 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7265 or yet unchecked. |
7266 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7267 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7268 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007270 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7271 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7272 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7273 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7274 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7275 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7276 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7277 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7278 servers.
7279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007280 Supported in default-server: Yes
7281
7282maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007283 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7284 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7285 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7286 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7287 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7288 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7289 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7290 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007292 Supported in default-server: Yes
7293
7294maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007295 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7296 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7297 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7298 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7299 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7300 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7301 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007303 Supported in default-server: Yes
7304
7305minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007306 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7307 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7308 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7309 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7310 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7311 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007312 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007313 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007315 Supported in default-server: Yes
7316
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007317no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007318 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7319 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007320 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007321
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007322 Supported in default-server: No
7323
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007324no-tls-tickets
7325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7326 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7327 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7328 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7329
7330 Supported in default-server: No
7331
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007332no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007333 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007334 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7335 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007336 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7337 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007338
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007339 Supported in default-server: No
7340
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007341no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007342 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007343 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7344 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007345 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7346 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007347
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007348 Supported in default-server: No
7349
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007350no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007351 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007352 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7353 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007354 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7355 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007356
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007357 Supported in default-server: No
7358
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007359non-stick
7360 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7361 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7362 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7363
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007364 Supported in default-server: No
7365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007366observe <mode>
7367 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7368 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7369 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7370 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7371 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7372 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007373 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007375 Supported in default-server: No
7376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007377 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7378
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007379on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007380 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7381 Currently, four modes are available:
7382 - fastinter: force fastinter
7383 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7384 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7385 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7386 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007388 Supported in default-server: Yes
7389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007390 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7391
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007392on-marked-down <action>
7393 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7394 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007395 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7396 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7397 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7398 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7399 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7400 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7401 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7402 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007403
7404 Actions are disabled by default
7405
7406 Supported in default-server: Yes
7407
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007408on-marked-up <action>
7409 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7410 Currently one action is available:
7411 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7412 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7413 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7414 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7415 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7416 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7417 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7418 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7419
7420 Actions are disabled by default
7421
7422 Supported in default-server: Yes
7423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007424port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007425 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7426 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7427 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7428 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7429 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7430 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007432 Supported in default-server: Yes
7433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007434redir <prefix>
7435 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7436 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7437 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7438 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7439 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7440 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7441 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7442 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007443 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007444 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7445 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7446 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7447 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7448 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7449
7450 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007452 Supported in default-server: No
7453
7454rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007455 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7456 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7457 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007459 Supported in default-server: Yes
7460
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007461send-proxy
7462 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7463 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7464 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7465 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7466 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7467 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7468 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7469 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7470 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007471 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7472 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7473 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7474 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7475 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007476
7477 Supported in default-server: No
7478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007479slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007480 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7481 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7482 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7483 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7484 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7485 parameters :
7486
7487 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7488 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7489
7490 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7491 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7492 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7493 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7494
7495 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7496 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7497 seen as failed.
7498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007499 Supported in default-server: Yes
7500
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007501source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007502source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007503source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007504 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7505 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7506 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7507 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7508
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007509 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7510 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7511 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7512 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7513 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7514 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7515 server.
7516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007517 Supported in default-server: No
7518
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007519ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007520 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7521 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7522 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7523 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7524 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7525 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7526 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7527 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7528
7529 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007531track [<proxy>/]<server>
7532 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7533 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7534 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7535 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7536 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007538 Supported in default-server: No
7539
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007540verify [none|required]
7541 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7542 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7543 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7544 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7545 is aborted.
7546
7547 Supported in default-server: No
7548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007549weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007550 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7551 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7552 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007553 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7554 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7555 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7556 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7557 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7558 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007560 Supported in default-server: Yes
7561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007562
75636. HTTP header manipulation
7564---------------------------
7565
7566In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7567response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7568request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7569which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7570against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7571to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7572passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7573headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7574never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7575
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007576There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7577(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7578rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7579messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7580in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007581happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007582add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7583normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007585This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7586in section 4.2 :
7587
7588 - reqadd <string>
7589 - reqallow <search>
7590 - reqiallow <search>
7591 - reqdel <search>
7592 - reqidel <search>
7593 - reqdeny <search>
7594 - reqideny <search>
7595 - reqpass <search>
7596 - reqipass <search>
7597 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7598 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7599 - reqtarpit <search>
7600 - reqitarpit <search>
7601 - rspadd <string>
7602 - rspdel <search>
7603 - rspidel <search>
7604 - rspdeny <search>
7605 - rspideny <search>
7606 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7607 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7608
7609With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7610is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7611parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7612prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7613Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7614
7615 \t for a tab
7616 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7617 \n for a new line (LF)
7618 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7619 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7620 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7621 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7622 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7623
7624The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7625portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7626above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7627regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
76289 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7629is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7630
7631The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7632after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7633
7634Notes related to these keywords :
7635---------------------------------
7636 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7637 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7638 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7639
7640 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7641 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7642 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7643
7644 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7645 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7646 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7647 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7648 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7649
7650 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7651 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7652 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7653 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7654 useless headers before adding new ones.
7655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007656 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007657 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7658
7659 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7660 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7661 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7662
7663 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7664 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007665 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007666
7667
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010076687. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7669------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007670
7671The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7672content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7673from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7674simple :
7675
7676 - define test criteria with sets of values
7677 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7678
7679The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7680
7681In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7682
7683 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7684
7685This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7686Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7687and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7688an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7689of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7690
7691ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7692'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7693which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7694
7695There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7696performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7697
7698The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7699
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007700 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7701 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007702 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7703
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007704The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7705specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7706possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007707multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7708be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7709needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7710space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7711match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7712lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7713duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007714to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007715instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007716
7717 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7718
7719In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7720the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7721case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7722too.
7723
7724Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7725a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7726ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007728Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007729
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007730 - integers or integer ranges
7731 - strings
7732 - regular expressions
7733 - IP addresses and networks
7734
7735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077367.1. Matching integers
7737----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007738
7739Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7740that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7741expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7742may be omitted.
7743
7744For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7745unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7746representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7747
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007748As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7749two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7750instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7751ranges and operators.
7752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007753For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007754operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7755Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7756of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007758Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007759
7760 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7761 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7762 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7763 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7764 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007766For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007767
7768 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7769
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007770This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7771
7772 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7773
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077757.2. Matching strings
7776---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007777
7778String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7779exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7780characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7781string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7782to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007783before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007784
7785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077867.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7787-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007788
7789Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7790they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7791possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7792passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7793the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007794the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7795match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007796
7797
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020077987.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007799----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007800
7801IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7802netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7803within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007804host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007805difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7806at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7807does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7808parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007809
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007810IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7811Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7812trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7813IPv6 patterns.
7814
7815HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7816following situations :
7817 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7818 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7819 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7820 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7821 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7822 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7823 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7824 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7825 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7826 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7827
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078297.5. Available matching criteria
7830--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078327.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7833------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007834
7835A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7836analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007837addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007838
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007839always_false
7840 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7841 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7842
7843always_true
7844 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7845 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7846
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007847avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007848avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007849 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7850 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7851 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7852 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7853 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7854 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7855 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7856 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7857 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7858 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7859 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007860
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007861be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007862be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007863 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7864 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7865 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7866 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7867 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007868
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007869be_id <integer>
7870 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7871 backend it was called.
7872
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007873be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007874be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007875 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7876 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7877 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7878 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7879 sucking of an online dictionary).
7880
7881 Example :
7882 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7883 backend dynamic
7884 mode http
7885 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7886 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007887
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007888connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007889connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007890 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007891 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007892 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007894 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7895 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007896
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007897 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007898 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7899 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7900 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7901 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7902 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007903 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007904
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007905 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7906 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7907 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7908 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007909
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007910dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007911 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7912 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007913
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007914dst_conn <integer>
7915 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7916 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7917 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7918 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7919 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7920 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7921
7922dst_port <integer>
7923 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7924 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7925
7926fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007927fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007928 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7929 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7930 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7931 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7932 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7933 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7934 criteria.
7935
7936fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007937 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007938 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007939
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007940fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007941fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007942 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7943 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7944 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7945 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7946 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7947 the rate to go down below the limit.
7948
7949 Example :
7950 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7951 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7952 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7953 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7954 frontend mail
7955 bind :25
7956 mode tcp
7957 maxconn 100
7958 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7959 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7960 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7961 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007962
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007963nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007964nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007965 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7966 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7967 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7968 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7969 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007970
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007971queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007972queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007973 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7974 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7975 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7976 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7977 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7978 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7979 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7980
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007981sc1_bytes_in_rate
7982sc2_bytes_in_rate
7983 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7984 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7985 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7986
7987sc1_bytes_out_rate
7988sc2_bytes_out_rate
7989 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7990 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7991 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7992
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007993sc1_clr_gpc0
7994sc2_clr_gpc0
7995 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7996 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7997 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7998 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7999 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8000 was verified :
8001
8002 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8003 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8004 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8005 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8006 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8007 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8008 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008010sc1_conn_cnt
8011sc2_conn_cnt
8012 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8013 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8014
8015sc1_conn_cur
8016sc2_conn_cur
8017 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8018 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8019 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8020
8021sc1_conn_rate
8022sc2_conn_rate
8023 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8024 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8025 See also src_conn_rate.
8026
8027sc1_get_gpc0
8028sc2_get_gpc0
8029 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8030 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8031
8032sc1_http_err_cnt
8033sc2_http_err_cnt
8034 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8035 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8036 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8037
8038sc1_http_err_rate
8039sc2_http_err_rate
8040 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8041 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8042 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8043 src_http_err_rate.
8044
8045sc1_http_req_cnt
8046sc2_http_req_cnt
8047 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8048 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8049 src_http_req_cnt.
8050
8051sc1_http_req_rate
8052sc2_http_req_rate
8053 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8054 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8055 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8056 src_http_req_rate.
8057
8058sc1_inc_gpc0
8059sc2_inc_gpc0
8060 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8061 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8062 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8063 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8064 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8065 when a first ACL was verified :
8066
8067 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8068 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8069 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8070
8071sc1_kbytes_in
8072sc2_kbytes_in
8073 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8074 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8075 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8076 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8077
8078sc1_kbytes_out
8079sc2_kbytes_out
8080 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8081 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8082 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8083 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8084
8085sc1_sess_cnt
8086sc2_sess_cnt
8087 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8088 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8089 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8090 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008091 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008092 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8093
8094sc1_sess_rate
8095sc2_sess_rate
8096 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8097 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8098 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8099 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8100 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008101 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008102
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008103so_id <integer>
8104 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8105
8106src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008107 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8108 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8109 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008110
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008111src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008112src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008113 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8114 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8115 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008116 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008117
8118src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008119src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008120 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8121 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8122 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008123 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008124
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008125src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8126src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8127 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8128 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8129 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8130 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8131 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8132 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8133
8134 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8135 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8136 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8137 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8138 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8139 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8140 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8141
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008142src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008143src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008144 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8145 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8146 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008147 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008148
8149src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008150src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008151 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8152 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8153 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008154 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008155
8156src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008157src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008158 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8159 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8160 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008161 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008162
8163src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008164src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008165 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8166 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8167 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008168 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008169
8170src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008171src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008172 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8173 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8174 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008175 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008176
8177src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008178src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008179 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8180 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8181 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8182 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008183 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008184
8185src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008186src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008187 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8188 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8189 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008190 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008191
8192src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008193src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008194 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8195 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8196 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8197 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008198 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008199
8200src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008201src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008202 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8203 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8204 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8205 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8206 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8207 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8208
8209 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8210 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008211 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008212
8213src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008214src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008215 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8216 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8217 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8218 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008219 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008220
8221src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008222src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008223 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8224 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8225 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8226 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008227 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008228
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008229src_port <integer>
8230 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008231
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008232src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008233src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008234 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8235 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8236 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8237 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008238 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008239
8240src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008241src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008242 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8243 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8244 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8245 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008246 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008247
8248src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008249src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008250 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008251 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8252 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008253 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8254 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8255 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008256 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008257
8258 Example :
8259 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8260 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8261 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8262 listen ssh
8263 bind :22
8264 mode tcp
8265 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008266 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008267 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8268 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8269
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008270srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008271 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8272 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8273 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8274 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8275
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008276srv_id <integer>
8277 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8278
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008279srv_is_up(<server>)
8280srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8281 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8282 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8283 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8284 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8285 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8286 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8287 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8288 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8289
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008290table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008291table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008292 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8293 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8294
8295table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008296table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008297 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8298 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8299 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8300
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020083027.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8303---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008304
8305A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8306during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008307through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8308keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008309
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008310rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8311 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8312 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8313 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008314 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8315 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8316 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008317
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008318req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008319 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008320 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8321 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8322 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8323 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8324 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8325 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8326
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008327req_proto_http
8328 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8329 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008330 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008331 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8332 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8333
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008334req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008335req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008336 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8337 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8338 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8339 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8340 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8341 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8342 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8343 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8344
8345req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008346req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008347 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8348 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8349 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8350 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8351 cookies.
8352
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008353req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8354 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8355 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8356 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008357 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8358 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8359 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008360
8361req_ssl_sni <string>
8362 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8363 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8364 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8365 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8366 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8367 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8368 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008369 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8370 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008371 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008372 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008373
8374 Examples :
8375 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8376 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8377 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8378 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8379 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8380
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008381req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8382 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8383 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8384 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8385 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8386 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8387 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008388 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8389 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008390 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008391 option.
8392
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008393ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8394 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8395 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8396 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8397 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8398 during this verification process.
8399
8400ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8401 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8402 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8403 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8404 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8405
8406ssl_c_err <integer>
8407 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8408 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8409 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8410 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8411
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008412ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8413ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8414 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8415 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8416 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8417 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8418 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8419 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8420 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8421 DN matches the specified string.
8422
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008423ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8424 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8425 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8426 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8427
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008428ssl_c_notafter <string>
8429 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8430 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8431 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8432
8433ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8434 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8435 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8436 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8437
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008438ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8439ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8440 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8441 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8442 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8443 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8444 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8445 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8446 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8447 DN matches the specified string.
8448
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008449ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8450 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8451 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8452 the value written in hexa.
8453
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008454ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8455 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8456 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8457 by the client matches the string.
8458
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008459ssl_c_verify <integer>
8460 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8461 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8462 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8463
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008464ssl_c_version <integer>
8465 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8466 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8467 the value.
8468
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008469ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8470ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8471 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8472 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8473 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8474 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8475 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8476 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8477 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8478 DN matches the specified string.
8479
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008480ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8481 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8482 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8483 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8484
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008485ssl_f_notafter <string>
8486 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8487 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8488 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8489
8490ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8491 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8492 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8493 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8494
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008495ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8496ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8497 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8498 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8499 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8500 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8501 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8502 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8503 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8504 DN matches the specified string.
8505
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008506ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8507 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8508 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8509 the value written in hexa.
8510
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008511ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8512 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8513 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8514 by the frontend matches the string.
8515
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008516ssl_f_version <integer>
8517 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8518 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8519 the value.
8520
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008521ssl_fc
8522 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8523 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8524 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8525
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008526ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8527 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8528 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8529
8530ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8531 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8532 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8533
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008534ssl_fc_has_crt
8535 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8536 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8537
8538ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008539 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008540 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8541 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8542 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8543 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008544
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008545ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008546 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8547 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8548 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8549 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008550 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8551 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8552 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008553
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008554ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8555 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8556 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8557
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008558ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008559 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8560 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8561 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8562 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008563 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8564 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008565 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8566 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8567 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008568
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008569ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008570 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8571 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8572 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8573 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008574 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8575 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8576 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8577 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008578
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008579ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008580 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8581 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8582 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8583 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008584 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8585 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8586 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8587 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008588
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008589ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8590 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8591 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8592
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008593wait_end
8594 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8595 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8596 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8597 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8598 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8599 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8600 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8601 inspection.
8602
8603 Examples :
8604 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8605 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8606 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8607
8608 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8609 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8610 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8611 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8612 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8613 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8614 tcp-request content reject
8615
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086177.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8618--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008619
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008620A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008621application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8622read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8623than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8624
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008625base <string>
8626 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8627 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8628 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8629 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8630 See also "path" and "uri".
8631
8632base_beg <string>
8633 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8634 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8635 "path_beg".
8636
8637base_dir <string>
8638 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8639 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8640 "path_dir" instead.
8641
8642base_dom <string>
8643 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8644 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8645 instead.
8646
8647base_end <string>
8648 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8649 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8650
8651base_len <integer>
8652 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8653 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8654
8655base_reg <regex>
8656 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8657 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8658 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8659 and all "base_" criteria.
8660
8661base_sub <string>
8662 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8663 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8664 also "base_dir".
8665
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008666cook(<name>) <string>
8667 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8668 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8669 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8670 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8671 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8672 sent by the server.
8673
8674 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8675 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8676 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8677
8678 cook(profile) silver gold
8679
8680cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8681 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8682 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8683 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8684
8685cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8686 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8687 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8688 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8689 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8690 server.
8691
8692cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8693 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8694 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8695 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8696 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8697 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8698
8699cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8700 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8701 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8702 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8703 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8704
8705cook_end(<name>) <string>
8706 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8707 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8708 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8709
8710cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8711 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8712 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8713 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8714 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8715 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8716
8717cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8718 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8719 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8720 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8721 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8722 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8723
8724cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8725 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8726 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8727 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8728
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008729cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8730 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8731 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8732 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8733 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8734 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008736hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008737hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008738 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8739 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8740 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8741 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008742 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8743 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8744 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8745 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8746 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008747
8748 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008749 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008750 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8751
8752 hdr(Connection) -i close
8753
8754hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008755hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008756 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8757 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8758 response headers sent by the server.
8759
8760hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008761hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008762 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8763 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8764 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8765 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8766 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8767 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8768 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8769
8770hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008771hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008772 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8773 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8774 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8775 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8776 headers sent by the server.
8777
8778hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008779hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008780 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8781 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8782 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8783 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8784 server.
8785
8786hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008787hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008788 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8789 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8790 response headers sent by the server.
8791
8792hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008793hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8794 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8795 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8796 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008797 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8798
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008799hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008800hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008801 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8802 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8803 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8804 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8805
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008806hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008807hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008808 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008809 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8810 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8811 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8812 response headers sent by the server.
8813
8814hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008815hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008816 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8817 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8818 response headers sent by the server.
8819
8820hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008821hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008822 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8823 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8824 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8825 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8826
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008827http_auth(<userlist>)
8828http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008829 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8830 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8831 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8832 of specified groups.
8833
8834 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8835
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008836http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008837 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8838 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8839 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8840 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008842method <string>
8843 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8844 already check for most common methods.
8845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008846path <string>
8847 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8848 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8849 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8850
8851path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008852 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8853 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008854
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008855path_dir <string>
8856 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8857 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8858 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8859 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8860
8861path_dom <string>
8862 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8863 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8864 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8865
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008866path_end <string>
8867 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8868 control file name extension.
8869
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008870path_len <integer>
8871 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8872 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8873
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008874path_reg <regex>
8875 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8876 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8877 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8878
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008879path_sub <string>
8880 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8881 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8882 "path_dir".
8883
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008884payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8885 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8886 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8887 strings.
8888
8889payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8890 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8891 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8892 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8893 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8894 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8895
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008896req_ver <string>
8897 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8898 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8899
8900status <integer>
8901 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8902 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8903 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8904
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008905url <string>
8906 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008907 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008908
8909url_beg <string>
8910 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008911 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8912 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008914url_dir <string>
8915 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8916 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8917 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8918 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8919
8920url_dom <string>
8921 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8922 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8923 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8924
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008925url_end <string>
8926 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8927 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008928
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008929url_ip <address>
8930 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8931 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8932 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008933
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008934url_len <integer>
8935 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8936 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8937
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008938url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008939 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8940 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008941 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008942 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008943
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008944url_reg <regex>
8945 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8946 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008947 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008948
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008949url_sub <string>
8950 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8951 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008952
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008953urlp(<name>) <string>
8954 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8955 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8956
8957 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8958 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8959
8960urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8961 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8962 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8963 protocol scheme.
8964
8965urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8966 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8967 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8968 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8969 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8970
8971urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8972 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8973 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8974 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8975 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8976
8977urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8978 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8979
8980urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008981 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8982 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008983
8984urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8985 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8986 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8987
8988urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8989 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8990 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8991 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8992 "urlp_" criteria.
8993
8994urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8995 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8996 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8997 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8998
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008999urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9000 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9001 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9002 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9003 negative data.
9004
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090067.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9007---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009009Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9010every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009011order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009013ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9014---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009015FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009016HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009017HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9018HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009019HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9020HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9021HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9022HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9023LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009024METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9025METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9026METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9027METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9028METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9029METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009030RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009031REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009032TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009033WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9034---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009035
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090377.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9038----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009040Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9041combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009043 - AND (implicit)
9044 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9045 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009047A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009049 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009051Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9052indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009054For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9055"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9056requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9057is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009059 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9060 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9061 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9062 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009064To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9065and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009067 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9068 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9069 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9070 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009072 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9073 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9074 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9075 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009076
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009077It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9078expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9079be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009080the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009081
9082 The following rule :
9083
9084 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9085 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9086
9087 Can also be written that way :
9088
9089 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9090
9091It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9092to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9093simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9094sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9095good use is the following :
9096
9097 With named ACLs :
9098
9099 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9100 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9101 monitor fail if site_dead
9102
9103 With anonymous ACLs :
9104
9105 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009107See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009108
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009109
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010091107.8. Pattern extraction
9111-----------------------
9112
9113The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9114response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9115for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9116
9117All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9118"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9119begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9120arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9121much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9122equivalent used in ACLs.
9123
9124The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9125
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009126 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9127 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9128 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9129 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9130 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9131 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9132 requested objects by host/path.
9133
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009134 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009135 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9136 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9137 according to RFC 4291.
9138
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009139 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9140 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9141 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009142 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9143 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9144 according to RFC 4291.
9145
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009146 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9147 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9148 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9149 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9150 type integer and only works with such tables.
9151
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009152 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9153 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9154 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9155 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9156 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9157 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9158 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009159 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009160
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009161 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9162 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9163 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9164 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9165 wiser to use "url" instead.
9166
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009167 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009168 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9169 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9170 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9171 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009172
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009173 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009174 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9175 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9176 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9177 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9178 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9179 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9180 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9181 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009182
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009183 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9184 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9185 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9186 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9187
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009188 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9189 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9190
9191 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9192 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9193 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9194
9195 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9196 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9197
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009198 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9199 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9200 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9201 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9202 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9203 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9204 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9205 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9206 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9207 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9208 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9209
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009210 ssl_c_key_alg
9211 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9212 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9213 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9214
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009215 ssl_c_notafter
9216 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9217 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9218 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9219
9220 ssl_c_notbefore
9221 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9222 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9223 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9224
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009225 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9226 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9227 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9228 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9229 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9230 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9231 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9232 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9233 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9234 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9235 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9236
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009237 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9238 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9239 layer.
9240
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009241 ssl_c_sig_alg
9242 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9243 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9244 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9245
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009246 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9247 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9248 error is encountered.
9249
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009250 ssl_c_version
9251 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9252 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9253 layer.
9254
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009255 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9256 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9257 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9258 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9259 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9260 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9261 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9262 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9263 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9264 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9265 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9266
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009267 ssl_f_key_alg
9268 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9269 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9270 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9271
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009272 ssl_f_notafter
9273 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9274 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9275 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9276
9277 ssl_f_notbefore
9278 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9279 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9280 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9281
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009282 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9283 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9284 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9285 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9286 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9287 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9288 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9289 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9290 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9291 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9292 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9293
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009294 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9295 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9296 layer.
9297
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009298 ssl_f_sig_alg
9299 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9300 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9301 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9302
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009303 ssl_f_version
9304 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9305 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9306 layer.
9307
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009308 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9309 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9310 otherwise zero.
9311
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009312 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9313 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9314 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9315
9316 ssl_fc_cipher
9317 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9318 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9319
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009320 ssl_fc_has_crt
9321 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9322 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9323
9324 ssl_fc_has_sni
9325 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009326 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9327 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009328 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009329 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009330
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009331 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009332 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9333 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9334 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9335 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009336 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009337
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009338 ssl_fc_protocol
9339 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection
9340 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9341
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009342 ssl_fc_session_id
9343 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9344 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9345 stick on a given client.
9346
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009347 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009348 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9349 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9350 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9351 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9352 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009353
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009354 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9355 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9356 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9357
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009358 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9359 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9360 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9361 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9362
9363 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9364 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9365 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9366 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9367 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9368 table for a given source address.
9369
9370 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9371 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9372
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009373 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009374 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009375 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9376 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9377 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9378 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9379 where cookies cannot be used.
9380
9381 Example :
9382 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9383 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9384 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9385 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009386
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009387 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009388 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9389 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9390 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9391 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009392
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009393 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9394 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9395 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9396 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9397 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9398 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9399 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009400
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009401 Example :
9402 listen tse-farm
9403 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9404 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9405 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9406 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9407 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9408 persist rdp-cookie
9409 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9410 # This is only useful makes sense if
9411 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9412 stick-table type string size 204800
9413 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9414 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9415 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009416
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009417 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9418 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009419
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009420 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009421 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009422 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9423 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9424 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9425 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9426 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9427 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009428
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009429 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009430
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009431 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009432 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9433 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9434 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9435
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009436 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9437 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9438 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9439 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9440 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009441
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009442 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009443
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009444
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009445The currently available list of transformations include :
9446
9447 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9448 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9449 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9450
9451 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9452 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9453 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9454
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009455 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009456 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9457 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9458 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9459 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9460
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094628. Logging
9463----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009464
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009465One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9466provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9467very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9468provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9469state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009470to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009471headers.
9472
9473In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9474about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9475send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9476
9477 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9478 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9479 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9480 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9481 at the termination.
9482
9483The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9484allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9485as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9486while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9487real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9488delay.
9489
9490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094918.1. Log levels
9492---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009493
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009494TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009495source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009496HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9497in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9498track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9499syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9500about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009501
9502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095038.2. Log formats
9504----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009505
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009506HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009507and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9508slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9509options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009510
9511 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9512 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9513 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9514 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9515 extents.
9516
9517 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9518 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9519 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9520 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9521 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9522
9523 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9524 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9525 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9526 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9527 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9528
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009529 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9530 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9531 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9532 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9533
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009534 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9535
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009536Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9537specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9538field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9539servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9540always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9541identifier.
9542
9543Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9544 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9545 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9546 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9547 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9548
9549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095508.2.1. Default log format
9551-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009552
9553This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9554as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9555format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9556
9557 Example :
9558 listen www
9559 mode http
9560 log global
9561 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9562
9563 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9564 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9565 (www/HTTP)
9566
9567 Field Format Extract from the example above
9568 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9569 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9570 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9571 4 'to' to
9572 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9573 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9574
9575Detailed fields description :
9576 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9577 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9578 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9579 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9580 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9581 and processed the connection.
9582 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9583
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009584In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9585"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9586connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9587
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009588It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9589will eventually disappear.
9590
9591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095928.2.2. TCP log format
9593---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009594
9595The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9596is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9597information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9598counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9599emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9600environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9601the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9602sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009603specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9604not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9605fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9606marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009607
9608 Example :
9609 frontend fnt
9610 mode tcp
9611 option tcplog
9612 log global
9613 default_backend bck
9614
9615 backend bck
9616 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9617
9618 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9619 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9620 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9621
9622 Field Format Extract from the example above
9623 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9624 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9625 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9626 4 frontend_name fnt
9627 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9628 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9629 7 bytes_read* 212
9630 8 termination_state --
9631 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9632 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9633
9634Detailed fields description :
9635 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009636 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9637 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9638 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9639 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9640 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009641
9642 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009643 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9644 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9645 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009646
9647 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9648 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9649 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9650 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9651
9652 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9653 and processed the connection.
9654
9655 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9656 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9657 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9658 applications.
9659
9660 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9661 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9662 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9663 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9664 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9665
9666 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9667 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9668 See "Timers" below for more details.
9669
9670 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9671 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9672 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9673 "Timers" below for more details.
9674
9675 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9676 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9677 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9678 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9679 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9680 details.
9681
9682 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9683 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9684 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9685 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9686 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9687
9688 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9689 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9690 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9691 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9692 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9693 for more details.
9694
9695 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009696 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009697 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9698 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9699 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009700 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009701
9702 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9703 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9704 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9705 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9706 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9707 caused by a denial of service attack.
9708
9709 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9710 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9711 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9712 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9713 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9714 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9715 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9716 denial of service attack.
9717
9718 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9719 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9720 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9721 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9722 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9723 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9724 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9725 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9726 be processed than on other servers.
9727
9728 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9729 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9730 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9731 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9732 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9733 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9734 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9735 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9736 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9737 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9738 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9739 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9740 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9741
9742 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9743 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9744 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9745 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9746 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9747 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9748 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9749 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9750
9751 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9752 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9753 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9754 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9755 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9756 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9757 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9758 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9759 occurs.
9760
9761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097628.2.3. HTTP log format
9763----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009764
9765The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9766is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9767the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9768are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9769emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9770generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9771"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9772which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009773frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9774is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009775
9776Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9777slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9778with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9779
9780 Example :
9781 frontend http-in
9782 mode http
9783 option httplog
9784 log global
9785 default_backend bck
9786
9787 backend static
9788 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9789
9790 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9791 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9792 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009793 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009794
9795 Field Format Extract from the example above
9796 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9797 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9798 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9799 4 frontend_name http-in
9800 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9801 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9802 7 status_code 200
9803 8 bytes_read* 2750
9804 9 captured_request_cookie -
9805 10 captured_response_cookie -
9806 11 termination_state ----
9807 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9808 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9809 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9810 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9811 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009812
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009813
9814Detailed fields description :
9815 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009816 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9817 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9818 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9819 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9820 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009821
9822 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009823 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9824 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9825 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009826
9827 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9828 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9829 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9830 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9831 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9832
9833 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9834 and processed the connection.
9835
9836 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9837 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9838 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9839
9840 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9841 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9842 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9843 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9844 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9845 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9846
9847 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9848 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9849 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9850 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9851 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9852 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9853
9854 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9855 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9856 See "Timers" below for more details.
9857
9858 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9859 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9860 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9861 below for more details.
9862
9863 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9864 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9865 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9866 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9867 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9868 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9869 for more details.
9870
9871 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9872 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9873 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9874 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9875 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9876 details.
9877
9878 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9879 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9880 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9881
9882 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9883 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9884 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9885 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9886 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9887 overflowing.
9888
9889 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9890 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9891 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9892 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9893 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9894 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9895 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9896 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9897
9898 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9899 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9900 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9901 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9902 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9903 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9904 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9905 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9906
9907 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9908 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9909 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9910 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9911 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9912 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9913 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9914
9915 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009916 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009917 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9918 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9919 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009920 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009921 system.
9922
9923 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9924 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9925 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9926 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9927 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9928 caused by a denial of service attack.
9929
9930 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9931 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9932 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9933 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9934 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9935 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9936 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9937 denial of service attack.
9938
9939 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9940 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9941 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9942 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9943 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9944 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9945 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9946 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9947 processed than on other servers.
9948
9949 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9950 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9951 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9952 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9953 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9954 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9955 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9956 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9957 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9958 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9959 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9960 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9961 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9962
9963 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9964 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9965 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9966 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9967 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9968 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9969 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9970 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9971
9972 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9973 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9974 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9975 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9976 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9977 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9978 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9979 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9980 occurs.
9981
9982 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9983 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9984 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9985 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9986 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9987 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9988 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9989 cookies" below for more details.
9990
9991 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9992 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9993 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9994 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9995 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9996 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9997 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9998 and cookies" below for more details.
9999
10000 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10001 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10002 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10003 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10004 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10005 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10006 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10007 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10008
10009
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200100108.2.4. Custom log format
10011------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010012
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010013The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10014mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010015
10016HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10017Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10018separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10019prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10020
10021Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10022variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10023string formats ("Q").
10024
10025Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10026HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10027
10028Flags are :
10029 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010030 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010031
10032 Example:
10033
10034 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10035 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10036
10037At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10038
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010039 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010040 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010041
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010042the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010043
10044 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010045 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010046 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10047
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010048and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10049
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010050 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010051 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10052
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010053Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10054
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010055 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010056 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010057 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10058 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10059 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10060 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010061 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010062 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010063 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010064 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010065 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10066 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10067 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010068 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010069 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10070 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10071 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010072 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010073 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010074 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10075 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010076 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010077 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10078 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10079 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10080 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10081 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10082 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010083 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10084 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10085 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010086 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010087 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010088 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010089 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10090 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10091 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10092 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010093 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010094 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010095 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010096 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10097 | | %s | server_name | string |
10098 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10099 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010100 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10101 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10102 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010103 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010104 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010105 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010106 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010107
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010108 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101108.3. Advanced logging options
10111-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010112
10113Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10114just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10115options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10116for more information about their usage.
10117
10118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101198.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10120------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010121
10122It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10123haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10124commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10125monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10126ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10127
10128 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10129 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10130 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10131 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10132
10133 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10134 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10135 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10136 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10137 such as other load-balancers.
10138
10139 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10140 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10141 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10142
10143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101448.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10145----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010146
10147The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10148what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10149or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10150"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10151just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10152log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10153after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10154is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10155with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10156with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10157
10158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101598.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10160------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010161
10162Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10163for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10164"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10165retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10166raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10167a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10168file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10169you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10170"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10171
10172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101738.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10174--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010175
10176Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10177multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10178them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10179"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10180logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10181error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10182and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10183too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10184useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10185alternative.
10186
10187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101888.4. Timing events
10189------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010190
10191Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10192reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10193the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10194frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10195mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10196
10197 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10198 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10199 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10200 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10201 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10202
10203 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10204 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10205 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10206 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10207 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10208
10209 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10210 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10211 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10212 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10213 connection never established.
10214
10215 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10216 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10217 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10218 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10219 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10220 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10221 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10222 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10223 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10224 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10225 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10226
10227 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10228 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10229 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10230 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10231 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10232
10233 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10234
10235 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10236 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10237 negative.
10238
10239These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10240protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10241that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010242due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010243close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10244session has been aborted on timeout.
10245
10246Most common cases :
10247
10248 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10249 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10250 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10251 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10252 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10253 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10254 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10255 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10256 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010257 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10258 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10259 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010260
10261 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10262 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10263 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10264 of ms on remote networks.
10265
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010266 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10267 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10268 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010269
10270 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10271 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10272 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10273 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10274 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10275 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10276 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10277 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10278 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10279 to the server until another one is released.
10280
10281Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10282
10283 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10284 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10285 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10286
10287 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10288 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10289 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10290
10291 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10292 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10293 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10294 flags.
10295
10296 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10297 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10298 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10299 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10300 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10301 the client connection was maintained open.
10302
10303 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10304 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10305 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10306 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10307
10308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103098.5. Session state at disconnection
10310-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010311
10312TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10313"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
103142-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10315each of which has a special meaning :
10316
10317 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10318 session to terminate :
10319
10320 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10321
10322 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10323 server explicitly refused it.
10324
10325 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10326 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10327 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10328 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10329 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10330 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10331
10332 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10333 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10334 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10335 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10336 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10337
10338 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10339 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10340 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10341 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10342 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10343
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010344 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10345 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10346
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010347 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10348 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10349 backup connections when going up.
10350
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010351 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10352
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010353 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10354 send or receive data.
10355
10356 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10357 send or receive data.
10358
10359 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10360 with nothing left in the buffers.
10361
10362 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10363
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010364 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010365 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10366
10367 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10368 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10369 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10370 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10371 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10372
10373 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10374 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10375
10376 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10377 server (HTTP only).
10378
10379 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10380
10381 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10382 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10383 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10384
10385 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10386 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10387 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10388
10389 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10390
10391 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10392 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10393
10394 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10395 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10396 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10397
10398 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10399 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010400 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10401 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010402
10403 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10404 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10405 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10406 another server.
10407
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010408 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010409 server.
10410
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010411 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10412 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10413 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10414 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10415
10416 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10417 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10418 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10419 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10420
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010421 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10422 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10423 "use-server" rule).
10424
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010425 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10426
10427 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10428 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10429
10430 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10431
10432 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10433 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10434 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10435
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010436 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10437 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10438 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10439 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10440 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10441
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010442 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10443
10444 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10445 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10446
10447 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10448
10449 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10450
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010451The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10452was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010453helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10454starvation, attacks, etc...
10455
10456The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10457alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10458easier finding and understanding.
10459
10460 Flags Reason
10461
10462 -- Normal termination.
10463
10464 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10465 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10466 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10467 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10468
10469 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10470 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10471 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10472 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10473 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10474 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010475
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010476 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10477 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010478 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010479
10480 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10481 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10482 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10483
10484 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10485 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10486 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10487 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10488 the server takes too long to respond.
10489
10490 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10491 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10492 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10493 long a time to respond.
10494
10495 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10496 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10497 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10498 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10499 and the client.
10500
10501 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10502 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10503 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10504 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10505 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10506 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10507
10508 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10509 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010510 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10511 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10512 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10513 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010515 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010516 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10517 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10518 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10519 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10520 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10521
10522 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10523 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10524 503 or 504 here.
10525
10526 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10527 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10528 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10529 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10530 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10531
10532 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10533 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010534 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010535 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10536 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10537
10538 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10539 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10540 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10541 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10542 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10543 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10544 between haproxy and the server.
10545
10546 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10547 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10548 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10549 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10550 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10551 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10552 solution is to fix the application.
10553
10554 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10555 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10556 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10557 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10558 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10559 external attacks.
10560
10561 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10562 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010563 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010564 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10565 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10566
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010567 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10568 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10569 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10570 the client.
10571
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010572 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10573 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10574 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10575 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010576 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10577 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10578 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10579 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10580 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010581
10582 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10583 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10584 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10585 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10586
10587 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10588 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10589 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10590 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10591
10592 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10593 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10594 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10595 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10596
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010597The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10598persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10599important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10600re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10601
10602 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10603
10604 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10605 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10606 set on a GET request.
10607
10608 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10609 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010610 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010611 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10612
10613 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10614 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10615 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10616
10617 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10618 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10619 already got a cookie.
10620
10621 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10622 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10623 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10624 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10625 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10626
10627 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10628 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10629 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10630
10631 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10632 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10633 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10634
10635 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10636 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10637
10638 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10639 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10640 then advertised in the response.
10641
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106438.6. Non-printable characters
10644-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010645
10646In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10647consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10648converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10649prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10650being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10651escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10652is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10653'}' when logging headers.
10654
10655Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10656issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10657containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10658
10659Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10660the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10661performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10662
10663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106648.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10665---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010666
10667Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10668achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010669section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010670cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10671the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10672the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010673locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010674not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10675user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10676a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10677wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10678
10679 Examples :
10680 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10681 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10682
10683 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10684 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10685
10686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10688---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010689
10690Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10691proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10692the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10693server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10694
10695Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10696response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010697section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010698
10699It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010700time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10701appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010702are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10703and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10704follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10705request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10706in the logs.
10707
10708 Example :
10709 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10710 listen proxy-out
10711 mode http
10712 option httplog
10713 option logasap
10714 log global
10715 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10716
10717 # log the name of the virtual server
10718 capture request header Host len 20
10719
10720 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10721 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10722
10723 # log the beginning of the referrer
10724 capture request header Referer len 20
10725
10726 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10727 capture response header Server len 20
10728
10729 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10730 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10731
10732 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10733 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10734
10735 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10736 capture response header Via len 20
10737
10738 # log the URL location during a redirection
10739 capture response header Location len 20
10740
10741 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10742 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10743 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10744 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10745 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10746
10747 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10748 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10749 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10750 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010751 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010752
10753 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10754 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10755 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10756 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10757 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010758 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010759
10760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107618.9. Examples of logs
10762---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010763
10764These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10765them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10766reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10767
10768 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10769 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10770 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10771
10772 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10773 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10774
10775 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10776 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10777 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10778
10779 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10780 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10781
10782 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10783 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10784 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10785
10786 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010787 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010788 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10789 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10790
10791 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10792 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10793 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10794
10795 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10796 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010797 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010798 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10799 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10800 to return the 502 and not the server.
10801
10802 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010803 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010804
10805 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10806 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10807 Nothing was sent to any server.
10808
10809 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10810 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10811
10812 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10813 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10814 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10815 send a 408 return code to the client.
10816
10817 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10818 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10819
10820 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10821 5 seconds ("c----").
10822
10823 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10824 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010825 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010826
10827 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010828 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010829 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10830 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10831 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10832 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10833 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010834
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108369. Statistics and monitoring
10837----------------------------
10838
10839It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10840mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10841CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10842Unix socket.
10843
10844
108459.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010846---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010847
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010848The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10849page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010851 0. pxname: proxy name
10852 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10853 for server)
10854 2. qcur: current queued requests
10855 3. qmax: max queued requests
10856 4. scur: current sessions
10857 5. smax: max sessions
10858 6. slim: sessions limit
10859 7. stot: total sessions
10860 8. bin: bytes in
10861 9. bout: bytes out
10862 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010863 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010864 12. ereq: request errors
10865 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010866 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010867 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10868 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010869 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010870 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10871 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10872 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10873 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10874 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10875 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10876 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10877 25. qlimit: queue limit
10878 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10879 27. iid: unique proxy id
10880 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10881 29. throttle: warm up status
10882 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10883 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010884 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010885 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10886 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10887 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010888 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010889 UNK -> unknown
10890 INI -> initializing
10891 SOCKERR -> socket error
10892 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10893 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10894 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10895 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10896 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10897 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10898 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10899 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10900 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10901 disable-on-404
10902 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10903 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10904 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010905 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10906 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010907 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10908 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10909 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10910 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10911 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10912 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010913 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10914 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10915 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10916 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010917 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10918 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010919
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109219.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010922-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010923
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010924The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010925must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10926is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10927a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10928risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10929followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10930given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10931then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10932to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010933
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010934It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10935on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10936own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010937
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010938clear counters
10939 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10940 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10941 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10942 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10943 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10944
10945clear counters all
10946 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10947 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10948 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10949
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010950clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10951 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10952
10953 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10954 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10955 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10956 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10957 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10958 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10959
10960 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10961
10962 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10963 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10964 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10965 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10966 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10967 the ACLs :
10968
10969 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10970 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10971 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10972 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10973 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10974 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10975
10976 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010977 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10978 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010979
10980 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010981 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010982 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010983 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10984 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10985 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10986 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010987
10988 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10989
10990 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010991 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010992 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10993 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010994 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10995 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10996 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010997
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010998disable frontend <frontend>
10999 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11000 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11001 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11002 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11003 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11004 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11005 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11006 on the stats page.
11007
11008 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11009 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11010
11011 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11012 level "admin".
11013
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011014disable server <backend>/<server>
11015 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11016 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11017 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11018 during the maintenance.
11019
11020 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11021 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11022
11023 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011024 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011025
11026 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11027 level "admin".
11028
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011029enable frontend <frontend>
11030 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11031 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11032 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11033 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11034 which was disabled.
11035
11036 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11037 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11038
11039 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11040 level "admin".
11041
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011042enable server <backend>/<server>
11043 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11044 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11045
11046 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011047 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011048
11049 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11050 level "admin".
11051
11052get weight <backend>/<server>
11053 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11054 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11055 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11056 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11057 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011058 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011059
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011060help
11061 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11062 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011063
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011064prompt
11065 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11066 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11067 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11068 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11069 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11070 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11071 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11072 command.
11073
11074quit
11075 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011076
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011077set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011078 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11079 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11080 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11081 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11082 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011083 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11084 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11085
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011086set maxconn global <maxconn>
11087 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11088 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11089 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11090 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11091 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11092 setting.
11093
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011094set rate-limit connections global <value>
11095 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11096 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11097 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11098 is passed in number of connections per second.
11099
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011100set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11101 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11102 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11103 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11104 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11105 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11106
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011107set timeout cli <delay>
11108 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11109 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11110 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11111
11112set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11113 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11114 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11115 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11116 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11117 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11118 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11119 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11120 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11121 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11122 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11123 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11124 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11125 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011126 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011127
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011128show errors [<iid>]
11129 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11130 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011131 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11132 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11133 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011134
11135 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11136 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11137 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11138 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11139 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11140 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11141 are reported too.
11142
11143 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11144 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11145 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11146 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11147 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11148 code.
11149
11150 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11151 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11152 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11153 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11154 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11155 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11156 line.
11157
11158 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011159 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11160 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011161 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11162 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11163
11164 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11165 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11166 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11167 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11168 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11169 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11170 00204+ minal\r\n
11171 00211 \r\n
11172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011173 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011174 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11175 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11176 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11177 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11178 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11179 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011180
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011181show info
11182 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11183
11184show sess
11185 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011186 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11187 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11188
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011189show sess <id>
11190 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11191 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11192 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11193 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11194 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
11195 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011196
11197show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11198 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11199 possible to dump only selected items :
11200 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11201 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11202 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11203 for example:
11204 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11205 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11206 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11207
11208 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011209 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11210 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011211 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11212 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11213 Nbproc: 1
11214 Process_num: 1
11215 (...)
11216
11217 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11218 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11219 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11220 (...)
11221 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11222
11223 $
11224
11225 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11226 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11227 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11228 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011229 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011230
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011231show table
11232 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11233 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11234 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11235 entries currently in use.
11236
11237 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011238 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011239 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11240 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011241
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011242show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011243 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11244 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11245 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011246 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11247
11248 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11249 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11250 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11251 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11252 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11253
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011254 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11255 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11256 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11257 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11258 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11259 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11260
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011261
11262 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011263 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11264 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011265
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011266 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011267 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011268 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011269 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11270 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11271 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11272 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011273
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011274 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011275 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011276 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11277 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011278
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011279 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11280 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011281 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011282 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11283 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011284
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011285 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11286 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011287 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011288 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11289 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11290
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011291 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11292 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11293 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11294 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11295 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11296
11297 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11298 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11299 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011300 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11301 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011302 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11303 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011304
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011305shutdown frontend <frontend>
11306 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11307 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11308 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11309 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11310 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11311 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11312 once it is terminated.
11313
11314 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11315 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11316
11317 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11318 level "admin".
11319
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011320shutdown session <id>
11321 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11322 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11323 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11324 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11325 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11326 flag in the logs.
11327
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011328shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11329 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11330 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11331 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11332 'K' flag in the logs.
11333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011334/*
11335 * Local variables:
11336 * fill-column: 79
11337 * End:
11338 */